moodle/lib/moodlelib.php
David Mudrák b7acd9be50 MDL-39023 Make get_language_dependencies() aware of circular dependency risk
The patch reimplements the core_string_manager::get_language_dependencies()
so that potentially mis-configured language packs with circular
dependencies or self dependency do not make the site unavailable.
Unit tests for the expected behaviour are added.
2013-04-08 14:31:27 +02:00

11476 lines
399 KiB
PHP

<?php
// This file is part of Moodle - http://moodle.org/
//
// Moodle is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
// it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
// the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
// (at your option) any later version.
//
// Moodle is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
// but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
// MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
// GNU General Public License for more details.
//
// You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
// along with Moodle. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
/**
* moodlelib.php - Moodle main library
*
* Main library file of miscellaneous general-purpose Moodle functions.
* Other main libraries:
* - weblib.php - functions that produce web output
* - datalib.php - functions that access the database
*
* @package core
* @subpackage lib
* @copyright 1999 onwards Martin Dougiamas http://dougiamas.com
* @license http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/gpl.html GNU GPL v3 or later
*/
defined('MOODLE_INTERNAL') || die();
/// CONSTANTS (Encased in phpdoc proper comments)/////////////////////////
/// Date and time constants ///
/**
* Time constant - the number of seconds in a year
*/
define('YEARSECS', 31536000);
/**
* Time constant - the number of seconds in a week
*/
define('WEEKSECS', 604800);
/**
* Time constant - the number of seconds in a day
*/
define('DAYSECS', 86400);
/**
* Time constant - the number of seconds in an hour
*/
define('HOURSECS', 3600);
/**
* Time constant - the number of seconds in a minute
*/
define('MINSECS', 60);
/**
* Time constant - the number of minutes in a day
*/
define('DAYMINS', 1440);
/**
* Time constant - the number of minutes in an hour
*/
define('HOURMINS', 60);
/// Parameter constants - every call to optional_param(), required_param() ///
/// or clean_param() should have a specified type of parameter. //////////////
/**
* PARAM_ALPHA - contains only english ascii letters a-zA-Z.
*/
define('PARAM_ALPHA', 'alpha');
/**
* PARAM_ALPHAEXT the same contents as PARAM_ALPHA plus the chars in quotes: "_-" allowed
* NOTE: originally this allowed "/" too, please use PARAM_SAFEPATH if "/" needed
*/
define('PARAM_ALPHAEXT', 'alphaext');
/**
* PARAM_ALPHANUM - expected numbers and letters only.
*/
define('PARAM_ALPHANUM', 'alphanum');
/**
* PARAM_ALPHANUMEXT - expected numbers, letters only and _-.
*/
define('PARAM_ALPHANUMEXT', 'alphanumext');
/**
* PARAM_AUTH - actually checks to make sure the string is a valid auth plugin
*/
define('PARAM_AUTH', 'auth');
/**
* PARAM_BASE64 - Base 64 encoded format
*/
define('PARAM_BASE64', 'base64');
/**
* PARAM_BOOL - converts input into 0 or 1, use for switches in forms and urls.
*/
define('PARAM_BOOL', 'bool');
/**
* PARAM_CAPABILITY - A capability name, like 'moodle/role:manage'. Actually
* checked against the list of capabilities in the database.
*/
define('PARAM_CAPABILITY', 'capability');
/**
* PARAM_CLEANHTML - cleans submitted HTML code. Note that you almost never want
* to use this. The normal mode of operation is to use PARAM_RAW when recieving
* the input (required/optional_param or formslib) and then sanitse the HTML
* using format_text on output. This is for the rare cases when you want to
* sanitise the HTML on input. This cleaning may also fix xhtml strictness.
*/
define('PARAM_CLEANHTML', 'cleanhtml');
/**
* PARAM_EMAIL - an email address following the RFC
*/
define('PARAM_EMAIL', 'email');
/**
* PARAM_FILE - safe file name, all dangerous chars are stripped, protects against XSS, SQL injections and directory traversals
*/
define('PARAM_FILE', 'file');
/**
* PARAM_FLOAT - a real/floating point number.
*
* Note that you should not use PARAM_FLOAT for numbers typed in by the user.
* It does not work for languages that use , as a decimal separator.
* Instead, do something like
* $rawvalue = required_param('name', PARAM_RAW);
* // ... other code including require_login, which sets current lang ...
* $realvalue = unformat_float($rawvalue);
* // ... then use $realvalue
*/
define('PARAM_FLOAT', 'float');
/**
* PARAM_HOST - expected fully qualified domain name (FQDN) or an IPv4 dotted quad (IP address)
*/
define('PARAM_HOST', 'host');
/**
* PARAM_INT - integers only, use when expecting only numbers.
*/
define('PARAM_INT', 'int');
/**
* PARAM_LANG - checks to see if the string is a valid installed language in the current site.
*/
define('PARAM_LANG', 'lang');
/**
* PARAM_LOCALURL - expected properly formatted URL as well as one that refers to the local server itself. (NOT orthogonal to the others! Implies PARAM_URL!)
*/
define('PARAM_LOCALURL', 'localurl');
/**
* PARAM_NOTAGS - all html tags are stripped from the text. Do not abuse this type.
*/
define('PARAM_NOTAGS', 'notags');
/**
* PARAM_PATH - safe relative path name, all dangerous chars are stripped, protects against XSS, SQL injections and directory traversals
* note: the leading slash is not removed, window drive letter is not allowed
*/
define('PARAM_PATH', 'path');
/**
* PARAM_PEM - Privacy Enhanced Mail format
*/
define('PARAM_PEM', 'pem');
/**
* PARAM_PERMISSION - A permission, one of CAP_INHERIT, CAP_ALLOW, CAP_PREVENT or CAP_PROHIBIT.
*/
define('PARAM_PERMISSION', 'permission');
/**
* PARAM_RAW specifies a parameter that is not cleaned/processed in any way except the discarding of the invalid utf-8 characters
*/
define('PARAM_RAW', 'raw');
/**
* PARAM_RAW_TRIMMED like PARAM_RAW but leading and trailing whitespace is stripped.
*/
define('PARAM_RAW_TRIMMED', 'raw_trimmed');
/**
* PARAM_SAFEDIR - safe directory name, suitable for include() and require()
*/
define('PARAM_SAFEDIR', 'safedir');
/**
* PARAM_SAFEPATH - several PARAM_SAFEDIR joined by "/", suitable for include() and require(), plugin paths, etc.
*/
define('PARAM_SAFEPATH', 'safepath');
/**
* PARAM_SEQUENCE - expects a sequence of numbers like 8 to 1,5,6,4,6,8,9. Numbers and comma only.
*/
define('PARAM_SEQUENCE', 'sequence');
/**
* PARAM_TAG - one tag (interests, blogs, etc.) - mostly international characters and space, <> not supported
*/
define('PARAM_TAG', 'tag');
/**
* PARAM_TAGLIST - list of tags separated by commas (interests, blogs, etc.)
*/
define('PARAM_TAGLIST', 'taglist');
/**
* PARAM_TEXT - general plain text compatible with multilang filter, no other html tags. Please note '<', or '>' are allowed here.
*/
define('PARAM_TEXT', 'text');
/**
* PARAM_THEME - Checks to see if the string is a valid theme name in the current site
*/
define('PARAM_THEME', 'theme');
/**
* PARAM_URL - expected properly formatted URL. Please note that domain part is required, http://localhost/ is not accepted but http://localhost.localdomain/ is ok.
*/
define('PARAM_URL', 'url');
/**
* PARAM_USERNAME - Clean username to only contains allowed characters. This is to be used ONLY when manually creating user accounts, do NOT use when syncing with external systems!!
*/
define('PARAM_USERNAME', 'username');
/**
* PARAM_STRINGID - used to check if the given string is valid string identifier for get_string()
*/
define('PARAM_STRINGID', 'stringid');
///// DEPRECATED PARAM TYPES OR ALIASES - DO NOT USE FOR NEW CODE /////
/**
* PARAM_CLEAN - obsoleted, please use a more specific type of parameter.
* It was one of the first types, that is why it is abused so much ;-)
* @deprecated since 2.0
*/
define('PARAM_CLEAN', 'clean');
/**
* PARAM_INTEGER - deprecated alias for PARAM_INT
* @deprecated since 2.0
*/
define('PARAM_INTEGER', 'int');
/**
* PARAM_NUMBER - deprecated alias of PARAM_FLOAT
* @deprecated since 2.0
*/
define('PARAM_NUMBER', 'float');
/**
* PARAM_ACTION - deprecated alias for PARAM_ALPHANUMEXT, use for various actions in forms and urls
* NOTE: originally alias for PARAM_APLHA
* @deprecated since 2.0
*/
define('PARAM_ACTION', 'alphanumext');
/**
* PARAM_FORMAT - deprecated alias for PARAM_ALPHANUMEXT, use for names of plugins, formats, etc.
* NOTE: originally alias for PARAM_APLHA
* @deprecated since 2.0
*/
define('PARAM_FORMAT', 'alphanumext');
/**
* PARAM_MULTILANG - deprecated alias of PARAM_TEXT.
* @deprecated since 2.0
*/
define('PARAM_MULTILANG', 'text');
/**
* PARAM_TIMEZONE - expected timezone. Timezone can be int +-(0-13) or float +-(0.5-12.5) or
* string seperated by '/' and can have '-' &/ '_' (eg. America/North_Dakota/New_Salem
* America/Port-au-Prince)
*/
define('PARAM_TIMEZONE', 'timezone');
/**
* PARAM_CLEANFILE - deprecated alias of PARAM_FILE; originally was removing regional chars too
*/
define('PARAM_CLEANFILE', 'file');
/**
* PARAM_COMPONENT is used for full component names (aka frankenstyle) such as 'mod_forum', 'core_rating', 'auth_ldap'.
* Short legacy subsystem names and module names are accepted too ex: 'forum', 'rating', 'user'.
* Only lowercase ascii letters, numbers and underscores are allowed, it has to start with a letter.
* NOTE: numbers and underscores are strongly discouraged in plugin names!
*/
define('PARAM_COMPONENT', 'component');
/**
* PARAM_AREA is a name of area used when addressing files, comments, ratings, etc.
* It is usually used together with context id and component.
* Only lowercase ascii letters, numbers and underscores are allowed, it has to start with a letter.
*/
define('PARAM_AREA', 'area');
/**
* PARAM_PLUGIN is used for plugin names such as 'forum', 'glossary', 'ldap', 'radius', 'paypal', 'completionstatus'.
* Only lowercase ascii letters, numbers and underscores are allowed, it has to start with a letter.
* NOTE: numbers and underscores are strongly discouraged in plugin names! Underscores are forbidden in module names.
*/
define('PARAM_PLUGIN', 'plugin');
/// Web Services ///
/**
* VALUE_REQUIRED - if the parameter is not supplied, there is an error
*/
define('VALUE_REQUIRED', 1);
/**
* VALUE_OPTIONAL - if the parameter is not supplied, then the param has no value
*/
define('VALUE_OPTIONAL', 2);
/**
* VALUE_DEFAULT - if the parameter is not supplied, then the default value is used
*/
define('VALUE_DEFAULT', 0);
/**
* NULL_NOT_ALLOWED - the parameter can not be set to null in the database
*/
define('NULL_NOT_ALLOWED', false);
/**
* NULL_ALLOWED - the parameter can be set to null in the database
*/
define('NULL_ALLOWED', true);
/// Page types ///
/**
* PAGE_COURSE_VIEW is a definition of a page type. For more information on the page class see moodle/lib/pagelib.php.
*/
define('PAGE_COURSE_VIEW', 'course-view');
/** Get remote addr constant */
define('GETREMOTEADDR_SKIP_HTTP_CLIENT_IP', '1');
/** Get remote addr constant */
define('GETREMOTEADDR_SKIP_HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR', '2');
/// Blog access level constant declaration ///
define ('BLOG_USER_LEVEL', 1);
define ('BLOG_GROUP_LEVEL', 2);
define ('BLOG_COURSE_LEVEL', 3);
define ('BLOG_SITE_LEVEL', 4);
define ('BLOG_GLOBAL_LEVEL', 5);
///Tag constants///
/**
* To prevent problems with multibytes strings,Flag updating in nav not working on the review page. this should not exceed the
* length of "varchar(255) / 3 (bytes / utf-8 character) = 85".
* TODO: this is not correct, varchar(255) are 255 unicode chars ;-)
*
* @todo define(TAG_MAX_LENGTH) this is not correct, varchar(255) are 255 unicode chars ;-)
*/
define('TAG_MAX_LENGTH', 50);
/// Password policy constants ///
define ('PASSWORD_LOWER', 'abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz');
define ('PASSWORD_UPPER', 'ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ');
define ('PASSWORD_DIGITS', '0123456789');
define ('PASSWORD_NONALPHANUM', '.,;:!?_-+/*@#&$');
/// Feature constants ///
// Used for plugin_supports() to report features that are, or are not, supported by a module.
/** True if module can provide a grade */
define('FEATURE_GRADE_HAS_GRADE', 'grade_has_grade');
/** True if module supports outcomes */
define('FEATURE_GRADE_OUTCOMES', 'outcomes');
/** True if module supports advanced grading methods */
define('FEATURE_ADVANCED_GRADING', 'grade_advanced_grading');
/** True if module controls the grade visibility over the gradebook */
define('FEATURE_CONTROLS_GRADE_VISIBILITY', 'controlsgradevisbility');
/** True if module supports plagiarism plugins */
define('FEATURE_PLAGIARISM', 'plagiarism');
/** True if module has code to track whether somebody viewed it */
define('FEATURE_COMPLETION_TRACKS_VIEWS', 'completion_tracks_views');
/** True if module has custom completion rules */
define('FEATURE_COMPLETION_HAS_RULES', 'completion_has_rules');
/** True if module has no 'view' page (like label) */
define('FEATURE_NO_VIEW_LINK', 'viewlink');
/** True if module supports outcomes */
define('FEATURE_IDNUMBER', 'idnumber');
/** True if module supports groups */
define('FEATURE_GROUPS', 'groups');
/** True if module supports groupings */
define('FEATURE_GROUPINGS', 'groupings');
/** True if module supports groupmembersonly */
define('FEATURE_GROUPMEMBERSONLY', 'groupmembersonly');
/** Type of module */
define('FEATURE_MOD_ARCHETYPE', 'mod_archetype');
/** True if module supports intro editor */
define('FEATURE_MOD_INTRO', 'mod_intro');
/** True if module has default completion */
define('FEATURE_MODEDIT_DEFAULT_COMPLETION', 'modedit_default_completion');
define('FEATURE_COMMENT', 'comment');
define('FEATURE_RATE', 'rate');
/** True if module supports backup/restore of moodle2 format */
define('FEATURE_BACKUP_MOODLE2', 'backup_moodle2');
/** True if module can show description on course main page */
define('FEATURE_SHOW_DESCRIPTION', 'showdescription');
/** Unspecified module archetype */
define('MOD_ARCHETYPE_OTHER', 0);
/** Resource-like type module */
define('MOD_ARCHETYPE_RESOURCE', 1);
/** Assignment module archetype */
define('MOD_ARCHETYPE_ASSIGNMENT', 2);
/** System (not user-addable) module archetype */
define('MOD_ARCHETYPE_SYSTEM', 3);
/**
* Security token used for allowing access
* from external application such as web services.
* Scripts do not use any session, performance is relatively
* low because we need to load access info in each request.
* Scripts are executed in parallel.
*/
define('EXTERNAL_TOKEN_PERMANENT', 0);
/**
* Security token used for allowing access
* of embedded applications, the code is executed in the
* active user session. Token is invalidated after user logs out.
* Scripts are executed serially - normal session locking is used.
*/
define('EXTERNAL_TOKEN_EMBEDDED', 1);
/**
* The home page should be the site home
*/
define('HOMEPAGE_SITE', 0);
/**
* The home page should be the users my page
*/
define('HOMEPAGE_MY', 1);
/**
* The home page can be chosen by the user
*/
define('HOMEPAGE_USER', 2);
/**
* Hub directory url (should be moodle.org)
*/
define('HUB_HUBDIRECTORYURL', "http://hubdirectory.moodle.org");
/**
* Moodle.org url (should be moodle.org)
*/
define('HUB_MOODLEORGHUBURL', "http://hub.moodle.org");
/**
* Moodle mobile app service name
*/
define('MOODLE_OFFICIAL_MOBILE_SERVICE', 'moodle_mobile_app');
/**
* Indicates the user has the capabilities required to ignore activity and course file size restrictions
*/
define('USER_CAN_IGNORE_FILE_SIZE_LIMITS', -1);
/**
* Course display settings
*/
define('COURSE_DISPLAY_SINGLEPAGE', 0); // display all sections on one page
define('COURSE_DISPLAY_MULTIPAGE', 1); // split pages into a page per section
/**
* Authentication constants.
*/
define('AUTH_PASSWORD_NOT_CACHED', 'not cached'); // String used in password field when password is not stored.
/// PARAMETER HANDLING ////////////////////////////////////////////////////
/**
* Returns a particular value for the named variable, taken from
* POST or GET. If the parameter doesn't exist then an error is
* thrown because we require this variable.
*
* This function should be used to initialise all required values
* in a script that are based on parameters. Usually it will be
* used like this:
* $id = required_param('id', PARAM_INT);
*
* Please note the $type parameter is now required and the value can not be array.
*
* @param string $parname the name of the page parameter we want
* @param string $type expected type of parameter
* @return mixed
*/
function required_param($parname, $type) {
if (func_num_args() != 2 or empty($parname) or empty($type)) {
throw new coding_exception('required_param() requires $parname and $type to be specified (parameter: '.$parname.')');
}
if (isset($_POST[$parname])) { // POST has precedence
$param = $_POST[$parname];
} else if (isset($_GET[$parname])) {
$param = $_GET[$parname];
} else {
print_error('missingparam', '', '', $parname);
}
if (is_array($param)) {
debugging('Invalid array parameter detected in required_param(): '.$parname);
// TODO: switch to fatal error in Moodle 2.3
//print_error('missingparam', '', '', $parname);
return required_param_array($parname, $type);
}
return clean_param($param, $type);
}
/**
* Returns a particular array value for the named variable, taken from
* POST or GET. If the parameter doesn't exist then an error is
* thrown because we require this variable.
*
* This function should be used to initialise all required values
* in a script that are based on parameters. Usually it will be
* used like this:
* $ids = required_param_array('ids', PARAM_INT);
*
* Note: arrays of arrays are not supported, only alphanumeric keys with _ and - are supported
*
* @param string $parname the name of the page parameter we want
* @param string $type expected type of parameter
* @return array
*/
function required_param_array($parname, $type) {
if (func_num_args() != 2 or empty($parname) or empty($type)) {
throw new coding_exception('required_param_array() requires $parname and $type to be specified (parameter: '.$parname.')');
}
if (isset($_POST[$parname])) { // POST has precedence
$param = $_POST[$parname];
} else if (isset($_GET[$parname])) {
$param = $_GET[$parname];
} else {
print_error('missingparam', '', '', $parname);
}
if (!is_array($param)) {
print_error('missingparam', '', '', $parname);
}
$result = array();
foreach($param as $key=>$value) {
if (!preg_match('/^[a-z0-9_-]+$/i', $key)) {
debugging('Invalid key name in required_param_array() detected: '.$key.', parameter: '.$parname);
continue;
}
$result[$key] = clean_param($value, $type);
}
return $result;
}
/**
* Returns a particular value for the named variable, taken from
* POST or GET, otherwise returning a given default.
*
* This function should be used to initialise all optional values
* in a script that are based on parameters. Usually it will be
* used like this:
* $name = optional_param('name', 'Fred', PARAM_TEXT);
*
* Please note the $type parameter is now required and the value can not be array.
*
* @param string $parname the name of the page parameter we want
* @param mixed $default the default value to return if nothing is found
* @param string $type expected type of parameter
* @return mixed
*/
function optional_param($parname, $default, $type) {
if (func_num_args() != 3 or empty($parname) or empty($type)) {
throw new coding_exception('optional_param() requires $parname, $default and $type to be specified (parameter: '.$parname.')');
}
if (!isset($default)) {
$default = null;
}
if (isset($_POST[$parname])) { // POST has precedence
$param = $_POST[$parname];
} else if (isset($_GET[$parname])) {
$param = $_GET[$parname];
} else {
return $default;
}
if (is_array($param)) {
debugging('Invalid array parameter detected in required_param(): '.$parname);
// TODO: switch to $default in Moodle 2.3
//return $default;
return optional_param_array($parname, $default, $type);
}
return clean_param($param, $type);
}
/**
* Returns a particular array value for the named variable, taken from
* POST or GET, otherwise returning a given default.
*
* This function should be used to initialise all optional values
* in a script that are based on parameters. Usually it will be
* used like this:
* $ids = optional_param('id', array(), PARAM_INT);
*
* Note: arrays of arrays are not supported, only alphanumeric keys with _ and - are supported
*
* @param string $parname the name of the page parameter we want
* @param mixed $default the default value to return if nothing is found
* @param string $type expected type of parameter
* @return array
*/
function optional_param_array($parname, $default, $type) {
if (func_num_args() != 3 or empty($parname) or empty($type)) {
throw new coding_exception('optional_param_array() requires $parname, $default and $type to be specified (parameter: '.$parname.')');
}
if (isset($_POST[$parname])) { // POST has precedence
$param = $_POST[$parname];
} else if (isset($_GET[$parname])) {
$param = $_GET[$parname];
} else {
return $default;
}
if (!is_array($param)) {
debugging('optional_param_array() expects array parameters only: '.$parname);
return $default;
}
$result = array();
foreach($param as $key=>$value) {
if (!preg_match('/^[a-z0-9_-]+$/i', $key)) {
debugging('Invalid key name in optional_param_array() detected: '.$key.', parameter: '.$parname);
continue;
}
$result[$key] = clean_param($value, $type);
}
return $result;
}
/**
* Strict validation of parameter values, the values are only converted
* to requested PHP type. Internally it is using clean_param, the values
* before and after cleaning must be equal - otherwise
* an invalid_parameter_exception is thrown.
* Objects and classes are not accepted.
*
* @param mixed $param
* @param string $type PARAM_ constant
* @param bool $allownull are nulls valid value?
* @param string $debuginfo optional debug information
* @return mixed the $param value converted to PHP type
* @throws invalid_parameter_exception if $param is not of given type
*/
function validate_param($param, $type, $allownull=NULL_NOT_ALLOWED, $debuginfo='') {
if (is_null($param)) {
if ($allownull == NULL_ALLOWED) {
return null;
} else {
throw new invalid_parameter_exception($debuginfo);
}
}
if (is_array($param) or is_object($param)) {
throw new invalid_parameter_exception($debuginfo);
}
$cleaned = clean_param($param, $type);
if ($type == PARAM_FLOAT) {
// Do not detect precision loss here.
if (is_float($param) or is_int($param)) {
// These always fit.
} else if (!is_numeric($param) or !preg_match('/^[\+-]?[0-9]*\.?[0-9]*(e[-+]?[0-9]+)?$/i', (string)$param)) {
throw new invalid_parameter_exception($debuginfo);
}
} else if ((string)$param !== (string)$cleaned) {
// conversion to string is usually lossless
throw new invalid_parameter_exception($debuginfo);
}
return $cleaned;
}
/**
* Makes sure array contains only the allowed types,
* this function does not validate array key names!
* <code>
* $options = clean_param($options, PARAM_INT);
* </code>
*
* @param array $param the variable array we are cleaning
* @param string $type expected format of param after cleaning.
* @param bool $recursive clean recursive arrays
* @return array
*/
function clean_param_array(array $param = null, $type, $recursive = false) {
$param = (array)$param; // convert null to empty array
foreach ($param as $key => $value) {
if (is_array($value)) {
if ($recursive) {
$param[$key] = clean_param_array($value, $type, true);
} else {
throw new coding_exception('clean_param_array() can not process multidimensional arrays when $recursive is false.');
}
} else {
$param[$key] = clean_param($value, $type);
}
}
return $param;
}
/**
* Used by {@link optional_param()} and {@link required_param()} to
* clean the variables and/or cast to specific types, based on
* an options field.
* <code>
* $course->format = clean_param($course->format, PARAM_ALPHA);
* $selectedgrade_item = clean_param($selectedgrade_item, PARAM_INT);
* </code>
*
* @param mixed $param the variable we are cleaning
* @param string $type expected format of param after cleaning.
* @return mixed
*/
function clean_param($param, $type) {
global $CFG;
if (is_array($param)) {
throw new coding_exception('clean_param() can not process arrays, please use clean_param_array() instead.');
} else if (is_object($param)) {
if (method_exists($param, '__toString')) {
$param = $param->__toString();
} else {
throw new coding_exception('clean_param() can not process objects, please use clean_param_array() instead.');
}
}
switch ($type) {
case PARAM_RAW: // no cleaning at all
$param = fix_utf8($param);
return $param;
case PARAM_RAW_TRIMMED: // no cleaning, but strip leading and trailing whitespace.
$param = fix_utf8($param);
return trim($param);
case PARAM_CLEAN: // General HTML cleaning, try to use more specific type if possible
// this is deprecated!, please use more specific type instead
if (is_numeric($param)) {
return $param;
}
$param = fix_utf8($param);
return clean_text($param); // Sweep for scripts, etc
case PARAM_CLEANHTML: // clean html fragment
$param = fix_utf8($param);
$param = clean_text($param, FORMAT_HTML); // Sweep for scripts, etc
return trim($param);
case PARAM_INT:
return (int)$param; // Convert to integer
case PARAM_FLOAT:
return (float)$param; // Convert to float
case PARAM_ALPHA: // Remove everything not a-z
return preg_replace('/[^a-zA-Z]/i', '', $param);
case PARAM_ALPHAEXT: // Remove everything not a-zA-Z_- (originally allowed "/" too)
return preg_replace('/[^a-zA-Z_-]/i', '', $param);
case PARAM_ALPHANUM: // Remove everything not a-zA-Z0-9
return preg_replace('/[^A-Za-z0-9]/i', '', $param);
case PARAM_ALPHANUMEXT: // Remove everything not a-zA-Z0-9_-
return preg_replace('/[^A-Za-z0-9_-]/i', '', $param);
case PARAM_SEQUENCE: // Remove everything not 0-9,
return preg_replace('/[^0-9,]/i', '', $param);
case PARAM_BOOL: // Convert to 1 or 0
$tempstr = strtolower($param);
if ($tempstr === 'on' or $tempstr === 'yes' or $tempstr === 'true') {
$param = 1;
} else if ($tempstr === 'off' or $tempstr === 'no' or $tempstr === 'false') {
$param = 0;
} else {
$param = empty($param) ? 0 : 1;
}
return $param;
case PARAM_NOTAGS: // Strip all tags
$param = fix_utf8($param);
return strip_tags($param);
case PARAM_TEXT: // leave only tags needed for multilang
$param = fix_utf8($param);
// if the multilang syntax is not correct we strip all tags
// because it would break xhtml strict which is required for accessibility standards
// please note this cleaning does not strip unbalanced '>' for BC compatibility reasons
do {
if (strpos($param, '</lang>') !== false) {
// old and future mutilang syntax
$param = strip_tags($param, '<lang>');
if (!preg_match_all('/<.*>/suU', $param, $matches)) {
break;
}
$open = false;
foreach ($matches[0] as $match) {
if ($match === '</lang>') {
if ($open) {
$open = false;
continue;
} else {
break 2;
}
}
if (!preg_match('/^<lang lang="[a-zA-Z0-9_-]+"\s*>$/u', $match)) {
break 2;
} else {
$open = true;
}
}
if ($open) {
break;
}
return $param;
} else if (strpos($param, '</span>') !== false) {
// current problematic multilang syntax
$param = strip_tags($param, '<span>');
if (!preg_match_all('/<.*>/suU', $param, $matches)) {
break;
}
$open = false;
foreach ($matches[0] as $match) {
if ($match === '</span>') {
if ($open) {
$open = false;
continue;
} else {
break 2;
}
}
if (!preg_match('/^<span(\s+lang="[a-zA-Z0-9_-]+"|\s+class="multilang"){2}\s*>$/u', $match)) {
break 2;
} else {
$open = true;
}
}
if ($open) {
break;
}
return $param;
}
} while (false);
// easy, just strip all tags, if we ever want to fix orphaned '&' we have to do that in format_string()
return strip_tags($param);
case PARAM_COMPONENT:
// we do not want any guessing here, either the name is correct or not
// please note only normalised component names are accepted
if (!preg_match('/^[a-z]+(_[a-z][a-z0-9_]*)?[a-z0-9]$/', $param)) {
return '';
}
if (strpos($param, '__') !== false) {
return '';
}
if (strpos($param, 'mod_') === 0) {
// module names must not contain underscores because we need to differentiate them from invalid plugin types
if (substr_count($param, '_') != 1) {
return '';
}
}
return $param;
case PARAM_PLUGIN:
case PARAM_AREA:
// we do not want any guessing here, either the name is correct or not
if (!preg_match('/^[a-z][a-z0-9_]*[a-z0-9]$/', $param)) {
return '';
}
if (strpos($param, '__') !== false) {
return '';
}
return $param;
case PARAM_SAFEDIR: // Remove everything not a-zA-Z0-9_-
return preg_replace('/[^a-zA-Z0-9_-]/i', '', $param);
case PARAM_SAFEPATH: // Remove everything not a-zA-Z0-9/_-
return preg_replace('/[^a-zA-Z0-9\/_-]/i', '', $param);
case PARAM_FILE: // Strip all suspicious characters from filename
$param = fix_utf8($param);
$param = preg_replace('~[[:cntrl:]]|[&<>"`\|\':\\\\/]~u', '', $param);
if ($param === '.' || $param === '..') {
$param = '';
}
return $param;
case PARAM_PATH: // Strip all suspicious characters from file path
$param = fix_utf8($param);
$param = str_replace('\\', '/', $param);
// Explode the path and clean each element using the PARAM_FILE rules.
$breadcrumb = explode('/', $param);
foreach ($breadcrumb as $key => $crumb) {
if ($crumb === '.' && $key === 0) {
// Special condition to allow for relative current path such as ./currentdirfile.txt.
} else {
$crumb = clean_param($crumb, PARAM_FILE);
}
$breadcrumb[$key] = $crumb;
}
$param = implode('/', $breadcrumb);
// Remove multiple current path (./././) and multiple slashes (///).
$param = preg_replace('~//+~', '/', $param);
$param = preg_replace('~/(\./)+~', '/', $param);
return $param;
case PARAM_HOST: // allow FQDN or IPv4 dotted quad
$param = preg_replace('/[^\.\d\w-]/','', $param ); // only allowed chars
// match ipv4 dotted quad
if (preg_match('/(\d{1,3})\.(\d{1,3})\.(\d{1,3})\.(\d{1,3})/',$param, $match)){
// confirm values are ok
if ( $match[0] > 255
|| $match[1] > 255
|| $match[3] > 255
|| $match[4] > 255 ) {
// hmmm, what kind of dotted quad is this?
$param = '';
}
} elseif ( preg_match('/^[\w\d\.-]+$/', $param) // dots, hyphens, numbers
&& !preg_match('/^[\.-]/', $param) // no leading dots/hyphens
&& !preg_match('/[\.-]$/', $param) // no trailing dots/hyphens
) {
// all is ok - $param is respected
} else {
// all is not ok...
$param='';
}
return $param;
case PARAM_URL: // allow safe ftp, http, mailto urls
$param = fix_utf8($param);
include_once($CFG->dirroot . '/lib/validateurlsyntax.php');
if (!empty($param) && validateUrlSyntax($param, 's?H?S?F?E?u-P-a?I?p?f?q?r?')) {
// all is ok, param is respected
} else {
$param =''; // not really ok
}
return $param;
case PARAM_LOCALURL: // allow http absolute, root relative and relative URLs within wwwroot
$param = clean_param($param, PARAM_URL);
if (!empty($param)) {
if (preg_match(':^/:', $param)) {
// root-relative, ok!
} elseif (preg_match('/^'.preg_quote($CFG->wwwroot, '/').'/i',$param)) {
// absolute, and matches our wwwroot
} else {
// relative - let's make sure there are no tricks
if (validateUrlSyntax('/' . $param, 's-u-P-a-p-f+q?r?')) {
// looks ok.
} else {
$param = '';
}
}
}
return $param;
case PARAM_PEM:
$param = trim($param);
// PEM formatted strings may contain letters/numbers and the symbols
// forward slash: /
// plus sign: +
// equal sign: =
// , surrounded by BEGIN and END CERTIFICATE prefix and suffixes
if (preg_match('/^-----BEGIN CERTIFICATE-----([\s\w\/\+=]+)-----END CERTIFICATE-----$/', trim($param), $matches)) {
list($wholething, $body) = $matches;
unset($wholething, $matches);
$b64 = clean_param($body, PARAM_BASE64);
if (!empty($b64)) {
return "-----BEGIN CERTIFICATE-----\n$b64\n-----END CERTIFICATE-----\n";
} else {
return '';
}
}
return '';
case PARAM_BASE64:
if (!empty($param)) {
// PEM formatted strings may contain letters/numbers and the symbols
// forward slash: /
// plus sign: +
// equal sign: =
if (0 >= preg_match('/^([\s\w\/\+=]+)$/', trim($param))) {
return '';
}
$lines = preg_split('/[\s]+/', $param, -1, PREG_SPLIT_NO_EMPTY);
// Each line of base64 encoded data must be 64 characters in
// length, except for the last line which may be less than (or
// equal to) 64 characters long.
for ($i=0, $j=count($lines); $i < $j; $i++) {
if ($i + 1 == $j) {
if (64 < strlen($lines[$i])) {
return '';
}
continue;
}
if (64 != strlen($lines[$i])) {
return '';
}
}
return implode("\n",$lines);
} else {
return '';
}
case PARAM_TAG:
$param = fix_utf8($param);
// Please note it is not safe to use the tag name directly anywhere,
// it must be processed with s(), urlencode() before embedding anywhere.
// remove some nasties
$param = preg_replace('~[[:cntrl:]]|[<>`]~u', '', $param);
//convert many whitespace chars into one
$param = preg_replace('/\s+/', ' ', $param);
$param = textlib::substr(trim($param), 0, TAG_MAX_LENGTH);
return $param;
case PARAM_TAGLIST:
$param = fix_utf8($param);
$tags = explode(',', $param);
$result = array();
foreach ($tags as $tag) {
$res = clean_param($tag, PARAM_TAG);
if ($res !== '') {
$result[] = $res;
}
}
if ($result) {
return implode(',', $result);
} else {
return '';
}
case PARAM_CAPABILITY:
if (get_capability_info($param)) {
return $param;
} else {
return '';
}
case PARAM_PERMISSION:
$param = (int)$param;
if (in_array($param, array(CAP_INHERIT, CAP_ALLOW, CAP_PREVENT, CAP_PROHIBIT))) {
return $param;
} else {
return CAP_INHERIT;
}
case PARAM_AUTH:
$param = clean_param($param, PARAM_PLUGIN);
if (empty($param)) {
return '';
} else if (exists_auth_plugin($param)) {
return $param;
} else {
return '';
}
case PARAM_LANG:
$param = clean_param($param, PARAM_SAFEDIR);
if (get_string_manager()->translation_exists($param)) {
return $param;
} else {
return ''; // Specified language is not installed or param malformed
}
case PARAM_THEME:
$param = clean_param($param, PARAM_PLUGIN);
if (empty($param)) {
return '';
} else if (file_exists("$CFG->dirroot/theme/$param/config.php")) {
return $param;
} else if (!empty($CFG->themedir) and file_exists("$CFG->themedir/$param/config.php")) {
return $param;
} else {
return ''; // Specified theme is not installed
}
case PARAM_USERNAME:
$param = fix_utf8($param);
$param = str_replace(" " , "", $param);
$param = textlib::strtolower($param); // Convert uppercase to lowercase MDL-16919
if (empty($CFG->extendedusernamechars)) {
// regular expression, eliminate all chars EXCEPT:
// alphanum, dash (-), underscore (_), at sign (@) and period (.) characters.
$param = preg_replace('/[^-\.@_a-z0-9]/', '', $param);
}
return $param;
case PARAM_EMAIL:
$param = fix_utf8($param);
if (validate_email($param)) {
return $param;
} else {
return '';
}
case PARAM_STRINGID:
if (preg_match('|^[a-zA-Z][a-zA-Z0-9\.:/_-]*$|', $param)) {
return $param;
} else {
return '';
}
case PARAM_TIMEZONE: //can be int, float(with .5 or .0) or string seperated by '/' and can have '-_'
$param = fix_utf8($param);
$timezonepattern = '/^(([+-]?(0?[0-9](\.[5|0])?|1[0-3](\.0)?|1[0-2]\.5))|(99)|[[:alnum:]]+(\/?[[:alpha:]_-])+)$/';
if (preg_match($timezonepattern, $param)) {
return $param;
} else {
return '';
}
default: // throw error, switched parameters in optional_param or another serious problem
print_error("unknownparamtype", '', '', $type);
}
}
/**
* Makes sure the data is using valid utf8, invalid characters are discarded.
*
* Note: this function is not intended for full objects with methods and private properties.
*
* @param mixed $value
* @return mixed with proper utf-8 encoding
*/
function fix_utf8($value) {
if (is_null($value) or $value === '') {
return $value;
} else if (is_string($value)) {
if ((string)(int)$value === $value) {
// shortcut
return $value;
}
// Lower error reporting because glibc throws bogus notices.
$olderror = error_reporting();
if ($olderror & E_NOTICE) {
error_reporting($olderror ^ E_NOTICE);
}
// Note: this duplicates min_fix_utf8() intentionally.
static $buggyiconv = null;
if ($buggyiconv === null) {
$buggyiconv = (!function_exists('iconv') or iconv('UTF-8', 'UTF-8//IGNORE', '100'.chr(130).'€') !== '100€');
}
if ($buggyiconv) {
if (function_exists('mb_convert_encoding')) {
$subst = mb_substitute_character();
mb_substitute_character('');
$result = mb_convert_encoding($value, 'utf-8', 'utf-8');
mb_substitute_character($subst);
} else {
// Warn admins on admin/index.php page.
$result = $value;
}
} else {
$result = iconv('UTF-8', 'UTF-8//IGNORE', $value);
}
if ($olderror & E_NOTICE) {
error_reporting($olderror);
}
return $result;
} else if (is_array($value)) {
foreach ($value as $k=>$v) {
$value[$k] = fix_utf8($v);
}
return $value;
} else if (is_object($value)) {
$value = clone($value); // do not modify original
foreach ($value as $k=>$v) {
$value->$k = fix_utf8($v);
}
return $value;
} else {
// this is some other type, no utf-8 here
return $value;
}
}
/**
* Return true if given value is integer or string with integer value
*
* @param mixed $value String or Int
* @return bool true if number, false if not
*/
function is_number($value) {
if (is_int($value)) {
return true;
} else if (is_string($value)) {
return ((string)(int)$value) === $value;
} else {
return false;
}
}
/**
* Returns host part from url
* @param string $url full url
* @return string host, null if not found
*/
function get_host_from_url($url) {
preg_match('|^[a-z]+://([a-zA-Z0-9-.]+)|i', $url, $matches);
if ($matches) {
return $matches[1];
}
return null;
}
/**
* Tests whether anything was returned by text editor
*
* This function is useful for testing whether something you got back from
* the HTML editor actually contains anything. Sometimes the HTML editor
* appear to be empty, but actually you get back a <br> tag or something.
*
* @param string $string a string containing HTML.
* @return boolean does the string contain any actual content - that is text,
* images, objects, etc.
*/
function html_is_blank($string) {
return trim(strip_tags($string, '<img><object><applet><input><select><textarea><hr>')) == '';
}
/**
* Set a key in global configuration
*
* Set a key/value pair in both this session's {@link $CFG} global variable
* and in the 'config' database table for future sessions.
*
* Can also be used to update keys for plugin-scoped configs in config_plugin table.
* In that case it doesn't affect $CFG.
*
* A NULL value will delete the entry.
*
* @global object
* @global object
* @param string $name the key to set
* @param string $value the value to set (without magic quotes)
* @param string $plugin (optional) the plugin scope, default NULL
* @return bool true or exception
*/
function set_config($name, $value, $plugin=NULL) {
global $CFG, $DB;
if (empty($plugin)) {
if (!array_key_exists($name, $CFG->config_php_settings)) {
// So it's defined for this invocation at least
if (is_null($value)) {
unset($CFG->$name);
} else {
$CFG->$name = (string)$value; // settings from db are always strings
}
}
if ($DB->get_field('config', 'name', array('name'=>$name))) {
if ($value === null) {
$DB->delete_records('config', array('name'=>$name));
} else {
$DB->set_field('config', 'value', $value, array('name'=>$name));
}
} else {
if ($value !== null) {
$config = new stdClass();
$config->name = $name;
$config->value = $value;
$DB->insert_record('config', $config, false);
}
}
if ($name === 'siteidentifier') {
cache_helper::update_site_identifier($value);
}
cache_helper::invalidate_by_definition('core', 'config', array(), 'core');
} else { // plugin scope
if ($id = $DB->get_field('config_plugins', 'id', array('name'=>$name, 'plugin'=>$plugin))) {
if ($value===null) {
$DB->delete_records('config_plugins', array('name'=>$name, 'plugin'=>$plugin));
} else {
$DB->set_field('config_plugins', 'value', $value, array('id'=>$id));
}
} else {
if ($value !== null) {
$config = new stdClass();
$config->plugin = $plugin;
$config->name = $name;
$config->value = $value;
$DB->insert_record('config_plugins', $config, false);
}
}
cache_helper::invalidate_by_definition('core', 'config', array(), $plugin);
}
return true;
}
/**
* Get configuration values from the global config table
* or the config_plugins table.
*
* If called with one parameter, it will load all the config
* variables for one plugin, and return them as an object.
*
* If called with 2 parameters it will return a string single
* value or false if the value is not found.
*
* @static $siteidentifier The site identifier is not cached. We use this static cache so
* that we need only fetch it once per request.
* @param string $plugin full component name
* @param string $name default NULL
* @return mixed hash-like object or single value, return false no config found
*/
function get_config($plugin, $name = NULL) {
global $CFG, $DB;
static $siteidentifier = null;
if ($plugin === 'moodle' || $plugin === 'core' || empty($plugin)) {
$forced =& $CFG->config_php_settings;
$iscore = true;
$plugin = 'core';
} else {
if (array_key_exists($plugin, $CFG->forced_plugin_settings)) {
$forced =& $CFG->forced_plugin_settings[$plugin];
} else {
$forced = array();
}
$iscore = false;
}
if ($siteidentifier === null) {
try {
// This may fail during installation.
// If you have a look at {@link initialise_cfg()} you will see that this is how we detect the need to
// install the database.
$siteidentifier = $DB->get_field('config', 'value', array('name' => 'siteidentifier'));
} catch (dml_exception $ex) {
// It's failed. We'll use this opportunity to disable cache stores so that we don't inadvertingly start using
// old caches. People should delete their moodledata dirs when reinstalling the database... but they don't.
cache_factory::disable_stores();
// Set siteidentifier to false. We don't want to trip this continually.
$siteidentifier = false;
throw $ex;
}
}
if (!empty($name)) {
if (array_key_exists($name, $forced)) {
return (string)$forced[$name];
} else if ($name === 'siteidentifier' && $plugin == 'core') {
return $siteidentifier;
}
}
$cache = cache::make('core', 'config');
$result = $cache->get($plugin);
if ($result === false) {
// the user is after a recordset
$result = new stdClass;
if (!$iscore) {
$result = $DB->get_records_menu('config_plugins', array('plugin'=>$plugin), '', 'name,value');
} else {
// this part is not really used any more, but anyway...
$result = $DB->get_records_menu('config', array(), '', 'name,value');;
}
$cache->set($plugin, $result);
}
if (!empty($name)) {
if (array_key_exists($name, $result)) {
return $result[$name];
}
return false;
}
if ($plugin === 'core') {
$result['siteidentifier'] = $siteidentifier;
}
foreach ($forced as $key => $value) {
if (is_null($value) or is_array($value) or is_object($value)) {
// we do not want any extra mess here, just real settings that could be saved in db
unset($result[$key]);
} else {
//convert to string as if it went through the DB
$result[$key] = (string)$value;
}
}
return (object)$result;
}
/**
* Removes a key from global configuration
*
* @param string $name the key to set
* @param string $plugin (optional) the plugin scope
* @global object
* @return boolean whether the operation succeeded.
*/
function unset_config($name, $plugin=NULL) {
global $CFG, $DB;
if (empty($plugin)) {
unset($CFG->$name);
$DB->delete_records('config', array('name'=>$name));
cache_helper::invalidate_by_definition('core', 'config', array(), 'core');
} else {
$DB->delete_records('config_plugins', array('name'=>$name, 'plugin'=>$plugin));
cache_helper::invalidate_by_definition('core', 'config', array(), $plugin);
}
return true;
}
/**
* Remove all the config variables for a given plugin.
*
* @param string $plugin a plugin, for example 'quiz' or 'qtype_multichoice';
* @return boolean whether the operation succeeded.
*/
function unset_all_config_for_plugin($plugin) {
global $DB;
// Delete from the obvious config_plugins first
$DB->delete_records('config_plugins', array('plugin' => $plugin));
// Next delete any suspect settings from config
$like = $DB->sql_like('name', '?', true, true, false, '|');
$params = array($DB->sql_like_escape($plugin.'_', '|') . '%');
$DB->delete_records_select('config', $like, $params);
// Finally clear both the plugin cache and the core cache (suspect settings now removed from core).
cache_helper::invalidate_by_definition('core', 'config', array(), array('core', $plugin));
return true;
}
/**
* Use this function to get a list of users from a config setting of type admin_setting_users_with_capability.
*
* All users are verified if they still have the necessary capability.
*
* @param string $value the value of the config setting.
* @param string $capability the capability - must match the one passed to the admin_setting_users_with_capability constructor.
* @param bool $include admins, include administrators
* @return array of user objects.
*/
function get_users_from_config($value, $capability, $includeadmins = true) {
global $CFG, $DB;
if (empty($value) or $value === '$@NONE@$') {
return array();
}
// we have to make sure that users still have the necessary capability,
// it should be faster to fetch them all first and then test if they are present
// instead of validating them one-by-one
$users = get_users_by_capability(context_system::instance(), $capability);
if ($includeadmins) {
$admins = get_admins();
foreach ($admins as $admin) {
$users[$admin->id] = $admin;
}
}
if ($value === '$@ALL@$') {
return $users;
}
$result = array(); // result in correct order
$allowed = explode(',', $value);
foreach ($allowed as $uid) {
if (isset($users[$uid])) {
$user = $users[$uid];
$result[$user->id] = $user;
}
}
return $result;
}
/**
* Invalidates browser caches and cached data in temp
*
* IMPORTANT - If you are adding anything here to do with the cache directory you should also have a look at
* {@see phpunit_util::reset_dataroot()}
*
* @return void
*/
function purge_all_caches() {
global $CFG;
reset_text_filters_cache();
js_reset_all_caches();
theme_reset_all_caches();
get_string_manager()->reset_caches();
textlib::reset_caches();
cache_helper::purge_all();
// purge all other caches: rss, simplepie, etc.
remove_dir($CFG->cachedir.'', true);
// make sure cache dir is writable, throws exception if not
make_cache_directory('');
// hack: this script may get called after the purifier was initialised,
// but we do not want to verify repeatedly this exists in each call
make_cache_directory('htmlpurifier');
}
/**
* Get volatile flags
*
* @param string $type
* @param int $changedsince default null
* @return records array
*/
function get_cache_flags($type, $changedsince=NULL) {
global $DB;
$params = array('type'=>$type, 'expiry'=>time());
$sqlwhere = "flagtype = :type AND expiry >= :expiry";
if ($changedsince !== NULL) {
$params['changedsince'] = $changedsince;
$sqlwhere .= " AND timemodified > :changedsince";
}
$cf = array();
if ($flags = $DB->get_records_select('cache_flags', $sqlwhere, $params, '', 'name,value')) {
foreach ($flags as $flag) {
$cf[$flag->name] = $flag->value;
}
}
return $cf;
}
/**
* Get volatile flags
*
* @param string $type
* @param string $name
* @param int $changedsince default null
* @return records array
*/
function get_cache_flag($type, $name, $changedsince=NULL) {
global $DB;
$params = array('type'=>$type, 'name'=>$name, 'expiry'=>time());
$sqlwhere = "flagtype = :type AND name = :name AND expiry >= :expiry";
if ($changedsince !== NULL) {
$params['changedsince'] = $changedsince;
$sqlwhere .= " AND timemodified > :changedsince";
}
return $DB->get_field_select('cache_flags', 'value', $sqlwhere, $params);
}
/**
* Set a volatile flag
*
* @param string $type the "type" namespace for the key
* @param string $name the key to set
* @param string $value the value to set (without magic quotes) - NULL will remove the flag
* @param int $expiry (optional) epoch indicating expiry - defaults to now()+ 24hs
* @return bool Always returns true
*/
function set_cache_flag($type, $name, $value, $expiry=NULL) {
global $DB;
$timemodified = time();
if ($expiry===NULL || $expiry < $timemodified) {
$expiry = $timemodified + 24 * 60 * 60;
} else {
$expiry = (int)$expiry;
}
if ($value === NULL) {
unset_cache_flag($type,$name);
return true;
}
if ($f = $DB->get_record('cache_flags', array('name'=>$name, 'flagtype'=>$type), '*', IGNORE_MULTIPLE)) { // this is a potential problem in DEBUG_DEVELOPER
if ($f->value == $value and $f->expiry == $expiry and $f->timemodified == $timemodified) {
return true; //no need to update
}
$f->value = $value;
$f->expiry = $expiry;
$f->timemodified = $timemodified;
$DB->update_record('cache_flags', $f);
} else {
$f = new stdClass();
$f->flagtype = $type;
$f->name = $name;
$f->value = $value;
$f->expiry = $expiry;
$f->timemodified = $timemodified;
$DB->insert_record('cache_flags', $f);
}
return true;
}
/**
* Removes a single volatile flag
*
* @global object
* @param string $type the "type" namespace for the key
* @param string $name the key to set
* @return bool
*/
function unset_cache_flag($type, $name) {
global $DB;
$DB->delete_records('cache_flags', array('name'=>$name, 'flagtype'=>$type));
return true;
}
/**
* Garbage-collect volatile flags
*
* @return bool Always returns true
*/
function gc_cache_flags() {
global $DB;
$DB->delete_records_select('cache_flags', 'expiry < ?', array(time()));
return true;
}
// USER PREFERENCE API
/**
* Refresh user preference cache. This is used most often for $USER
* object that is stored in session, but it also helps with performance in cron script.
*
* Preferences for each user are loaded on first use on every page, then again after the timeout expires.
*
* @package core
* @category preference
* @access public
* @param stdClass $user User object. Preferences are preloaded into 'preference' property
* @param int $cachelifetime Cache life time on the current page (in seconds)
* @throws coding_exception
* @return null
*/
function check_user_preferences_loaded(stdClass $user, $cachelifetime = 120) {
global $DB;
static $loadedusers = array(); // Static cache, we need to check on each page load, not only every 2 minutes.
if (!isset($user->id)) {
throw new coding_exception('Invalid $user parameter in check_user_preferences_loaded() call, missing id field');
}
if (empty($user->id) or isguestuser($user->id)) {
// No permanent storage for not-logged-in users and guest
if (!isset($user->preference)) {
$user->preference = array();
}
return;
}
$timenow = time();
if (isset($loadedusers[$user->id]) and isset($user->preference) and isset($user->preference['_lastloaded'])) {
// Already loaded at least once on this page. Are we up to date?
if ($user->preference['_lastloaded'] + $cachelifetime > $timenow) {
// no need to reload - we are on the same page and we loaded prefs just a moment ago
return;
} else if (!get_cache_flag('userpreferenceschanged', $user->id, $user->preference['_lastloaded'])) {
// no change since the lastcheck on this page
$user->preference['_lastloaded'] = $timenow;
return;
}
}
// OK, so we have to reload all preferences
$loadedusers[$user->id] = true;
$user->preference = $DB->get_records_menu('user_preferences', array('userid'=>$user->id), '', 'name,value'); // All values
$user->preference['_lastloaded'] = $timenow;
}
/**
* Called from set/unset_user_preferences, so that the prefs can
* be correctly reloaded in different sessions.
*
* NOTE: internal function, do not call from other code.
*
* @package core
* @access private
* @param integer $userid the user whose prefs were changed.
*/
function mark_user_preferences_changed($userid) {
global $CFG;
if (empty($userid) or isguestuser($userid)) {
// no cache flags for guest and not-logged-in users
return;
}
set_cache_flag('userpreferenceschanged', $userid, 1, time() + $CFG->sessiontimeout);
}
/**
* Sets a preference for the specified user.
*
* If a $user object is submitted it's 'preference' property is used for the preferences cache.
*
* @package core
* @category preference
* @access public
* @param string $name The key to set as preference for the specified user
* @param string $value The value to set for the $name key in the specified user's
* record, null means delete current value.
* @param stdClass|int|null $user A moodle user object or id, null means current user
* @throws coding_exception
* @return bool Always true or exception
*/
function set_user_preference($name, $value, $user = null) {
global $USER, $DB;
if (empty($name) or is_numeric($name) or $name === '_lastloaded') {
throw new coding_exception('Invalid preference name in set_user_preference() call');
}
if (is_null($value)) {
// null means delete current
return unset_user_preference($name, $user);
} else if (is_object($value)) {
throw new coding_exception('Invalid value in set_user_preference() call, objects are not allowed');
} else if (is_array($value)) {
throw new coding_exception('Invalid value in set_user_preference() call, arrays are not allowed');
}
$value = (string)$value;
if (textlib::strlen($value) > 1333) { //value column maximum length is 1333 characters
throw new coding_exception('Invalid value in set_user_preference() call, value is is too long for the value column');
}
if (is_null($user)) {
$user = $USER;
} else if (isset($user->id)) {
// $user is valid object
} else if (is_numeric($user)) {
$user = (object)array('id'=>(int)$user);
} else {
throw new coding_exception('Invalid $user parameter in set_user_preference() call');
}
check_user_preferences_loaded($user);
if (empty($user->id) or isguestuser($user->id)) {
// no permanent storage for not-logged-in users and guest
$user->preference[$name] = $value;
return true;
}
if ($preference = $DB->get_record('user_preferences', array('userid'=>$user->id, 'name'=>$name))) {
if ($preference->value === $value and isset($user->preference[$name]) and $user->preference[$name] === $value) {
// preference already set to this value
return true;
}
$DB->set_field('user_preferences', 'value', $value, array('id'=>$preference->id));
} else {
$preference = new stdClass();
$preference->userid = $user->id;
$preference->name = $name;
$preference->value = $value;
$DB->insert_record('user_preferences', $preference);
}
// update value in cache
$user->preference[$name] = $value;
// set reload flag for other sessions
mark_user_preferences_changed($user->id);
return true;
}
/**
* Sets a whole array of preferences for the current user
*
* If a $user object is submitted it's 'preference' property is used for the preferences cache.
*
* @package core
* @category preference
* @access public
* @param array $prefarray An array of key/value pairs to be set
* @param stdClass|int|null $user A moodle user object or id, null means current user
* @return bool Always true or exception
*/
function set_user_preferences(array $prefarray, $user = null) {
foreach ($prefarray as $name => $value) {
set_user_preference($name, $value, $user);
}
return true;
}
/**
* Unsets a preference completely by deleting it from the database
*
* If a $user object is submitted it's 'preference' property is used for the preferences cache.
*
* @package core
* @category preference
* @access public
* @param string $name The key to unset as preference for the specified user
* @param stdClass|int|null $user A moodle user object or id, null means current user
* @throws coding_exception
* @return bool Always true or exception
*/
function unset_user_preference($name, $user = null) {
global $USER, $DB;
if (empty($name) or is_numeric($name) or $name === '_lastloaded') {
throw new coding_exception('Invalid preference name in unset_user_preference() call');
}
if (is_null($user)) {
$user = $USER;
} else if (isset($user->id)) {
// $user is valid object
} else if (is_numeric($user)) {
$user = (object)array('id'=>(int)$user);
} else {
throw new coding_exception('Invalid $user parameter in unset_user_preference() call');
}
check_user_preferences_loaded($user);
if (empty($user->id) or isguestuser($user->id)) {
// no permanent storage for not-logged-in user and guest
unset($user->preference[$name]);
return true;
}
// delete from DB
$DB->delete_records('user_preferences', array('userid'=>$user->id, 'name'=>$name));
// delete the preference from cache
unset($user->preference[$name]);
// set reload flag for other sessions
mark_user_preferences_changed($user->id);
return true;
}
/**
* Used to fetch user preference(s)
*
* If no arguments are supplied this function will return
* all of the current user preferences as an array.
*
* If a name is specified then this function
* attempts to return that particular preference value. If
* none is found, then the optional value $default is returned,
* otherwise NULL.
*
* If a $user object is submitted it's 'preference' property is used for the preferences cache.
*
* @package core
* @category preference
* @access public
* @param string $name Name of the key to use in finding a preference value
* @param mixed|null $default Value to be returned if the $name key is not set in the user preferences
* @param stdClass|int|null $user A moodle user object or id, null means current user
* @throws coding_exception
* @return string|mixed|null A string containing the value of a single preference. An
* array with all of the preferences or null
*/
function get_user_preferences($name = null, $default = null, $user = null) {
global $USER;
if (is_null($name)) {
// all prefs
} else if (is_numeric($name) or $name === '_lastloaded') {
throw new coding_exception('Invalid preference name in get_user_preferences() call');
}
if (is_null($user)) {
$user = $USER;
} else if (isset($user->id)) {
// $user is valid object
} else if (is_numeric($user)) {
$user = (object)array('id'=>(int)$user);
} else {
throw new coding_exception('Invalid $user parameter in get_user_preferences() call');
}
check_user_preferences_loaded($user);
if (empty($name)) {
return $user->preference; // All values
} else if (isset($user->preference[$name])) {
return $user->preference[$name]; // The single string value
} else {
return $default; // Default value (null if not specified)
}
}
/// FUNCTIONS FOR HANDLING TIME ////////////////////////////////////////////
/**
* Given date parts in user time produce a GMT timestamp.
*
* @package core
* @category time
* @param int $year The year part to create timestamp of
* @param int $month The month part to create timestamp of
* @param int $day The day part to create timestamp of
* @param int $hour The hour part to create timestamp of
* @param int $minute The minute part to create timestamp of
* @param int $second The second part to create timestamp of
* @param int|float|string $timezone Timezone modifier, used to calculate GMT time offset.
* if 99 then default user's timezone is used {@link http://docs.moodle.org/dev/Time_API#Timezone}
* @param bool $applydst Toggle Daylight Saving Time, default true, will be
* applied only if timezone is 99 or string.
* @return int GMT timestamp
*/
function make_timestamp($year, $month=1, $day=1, $hour=0, $minute=0, $second=0, $timezone=99, $applydst=true) {
//save input timezone, required for dst offset check.
$passedtimezone = $timezone;
$timezone = get_user_timezone_offset($timezone);
if (abs($timezone) > 13) { //server time
$time = mktime((int)$hour, (int)$minute, (int)$second, (int)$month, (int)$day, (int)$year);
} else {
$time = gmmktime((int)$hour, (int)$minute, (int)$second, (int)$month, (int)$day, (int)$year);
$time = usertime($time, $timezone);
//Apply dst for string timezones or if 99 then try dst offset with user's default timezone
if ($applydst && ((99 == $passedtimezone) || !is_numeric($passedtimezone))) {
$time -= dst_offset_on($time, $passedtimezone);
}
}
return $time;
}
/**
* Format a date/time (seconds) as weeks, days, hours etc as needed
*
* Given an amount of time in seconds, returns string
* formatted nicely as weeks, days, hours etc as needed
*
* @package core
* @category time
* @uses MINSECS
* @uses HOURSECS
* @uses DAYSECS
* @uses YEARSECS
* @param int $totalsecs Time in seconds
* @param object $str Should be a time object
* @return string A nicely formatted date/time string
*/
function format_time($totalsecs, $str=NULL) {
$totalsecs = abs($totalsecs);
if (!$str) { // Create the str structure the slow way
$str = new stdClass();
$str->day = get_string('day');
$str->days = get_string('days');
$str->hour = get_string('hour');
$str->hours = get_string('hours');
$str->min = get_string('min');
$str->mins = get_string('mins');
$str->sec = get_string('sec');
$str->secs = get_string('secs');
$str->year = get_string('year');
$str->years = get_string('years');
}
$years = floor($totalsecs/YEARSECS);
$remainder = $totalsecs - ($years*YEARSECS);
$days = floor($remainder/DAYSECS);
$remainder = $totalsecs - ($days*DAYSECS);
$hours = floor($remainder/HOURSECS);
$remainder = $remainder - ($hours*HOURSECS);
$mins = floor($remainder/MINSECS);
$secs = $remainder - ($mins*MINSECS);
$ss = ($secs == 1) ? $str->sec : $str->secs;
$sm = ($mins == 1) ? $str->min : $str->mins;
$sh = ($hours == 1) ? $str->hour : $str->hours;
$sd = ($days == 1) ? $str->day : $str->days;
$sy = ($years == 1) ? $str->year : $str->years;
$oyears = '';
$odays = '';
$ohours = '';
$omins = '';
$osecs = '';
if ($years) $oyears = $years .' '. $sy;
if ($days) $odays = $days .' '. $sd;
if ($hours) $ohours = $hours .' '. $sh;
if ($mins) $omins = $mins .' '. $sm;
if ($secs) $osecs = $secs .' '. $ss;
if ($years) return trim($oyears .' '. $odays);
if ($days) return trim($odays .' '. $ohours);
if ($hours) return trim($ohours .' '. $omins);
if ($mins) return trim($omins .' '. $osecs);
if ($secs) return $osecs;
return get_string('now');
}
/**
* Returns a formatted string that represents a date in user time
*
* Returns a formatted string that represents a date in user time
* <b>WARNING: note that the format is for strftime(), not date().</b>
* Because of a bug in most Windows time libraries, we can't use
* the nicer %e, so we have to use %d which has leading zeroes.
* A lot of the fuss in the function is just getting rid of these leading
* zeroes as efficiently as possible.
*
* If parameter fixday = true (default), then take off leading
* zero from %d, else maintain it.
*
* @package core
* @category time
* @param int $date the timestamp in UTC, as obtained from the database.
* @param string $format strftime format. You should probably get this using
* get_string('strftime...', 'langconfig');
* @param int|float|string $timezone by default, uses the user's time zone. if numeric and
* not 99 then daylight saving will not be added.
* {@link http://docs.moodle.org/dev/Time_API#Timezone}
* @param bool $fixday If true (default) then the leading zero from %d is removed.
* If false then the leading zero is maintained.
* @param bool $fixhour If true (default) then the leading zero from %I is removed.
* @return string the formatted date/time.
*/
function userdate($date, $format = '', $timezone = 99, $fixday = true, $fixhour = true) {
global $CFG;
if (empty($format)) {
$format = get_string('strftimedaydatetime', 'langconfig');
}
if (!empty($CFG->nofixday)) { // Config.php can force %d not to be fixed.
$fixday = false;
} else if ($fixday) {
$formatnoday = str_replace('%d', 'DD', $format);
$fixday = ($formatnoday != $format);
$format = $formatnoday;
}
// Note: This logic about fixing 12-hour time to remove unnecessary leading
// zero is required because on Windows, PHP strftime function does not
// support the correct 'hour without leading zero' parameter (%l).
if (!empty($CFG->nofixhour)) {
// Config.php can force %I not to be fixed.
$fixhour = false;
} else if ($fixhour) {
$formatnohour = str_replace('%I', 'HH', $format);
$fixhour = ($formatnohour != $format);
$format = $formatnohour;
}
//add daylight saving offset for string timezones only, as we can't get dst for
//float values. if timezone is 99 (user default timezone), then try update dst.
if ((99 == $timezone) || !is_numeric($timezone)) {
$date += dst_offset_on($date, $timezone);
}
$timezone = get_user_timezone_offset($timezone);
// If we are running under Windows convert to windows encoding and then back to UTF-8
// (because it's impossible to specify UTF-8 to fetch locale info in Win32)
if (abs($timezone) > 13) { /// Server time
$datestring = date_format_string($date, $format, $timezone);
if ($fixday) {
$daystring = ltrim(str_replace(array(' 0', ' '), '', strftime(' %d', $date)));
$datestring = str_replace('DD', $daystring, $datestring);
}
if ($fixhour) {
$hourstring = ltrim(str_replace(array(' 0', ' '), '', strftime(' %I', $date)));
$datestring = str_replace('HH', $hourstring, $datestring);
}
} else {
$date += (int)($timezone * 3600);
$datestring = date_format_string($date, $format, $timezone);
if ($fixday) {
$daystring = ltrim(str_replace(array(' 0', ' '), '', gmstrftime(' %d', $date)));
$datestring = str_replace('DD', $daystring, $datestring);
}
if ($fixhour) {
$hourstring = ltrim(str_replace(array(' 0', ' '), '', gmstrftime(' %I', $date)));
$datestring = str_replace('HH', $hourstring, $datestring);
}
}
return $datestring;
}
/**
* Returns a formatted date ensuring it is UTF-8.
*
* If we are running under Windows convert to Windows encoding and then back to UTF-8
* (because it's impossible to specify UTF-8 to fetch locale info in Win32).
*
* This function does not do any calculation regarding the user preferences and should
* therefore receive the final date timestamp, format and timezone. Timezone being only used
* to differenciate the use of server time or not (strftime() against gmstrftime()).
*
* @param int $date the timestamp.
* @param string $format strftime format.
* @param int|float $timezone the numerical timezone, typically returned by {@link get_user_timezone_offset()}.
* @return string the formatted date/time.
* @since 2.3.3
*/
function date_format_string($date, $format, $tz = 99) {
global $CFG;
if (abs($tz) > 13) {
if ($CFG->ostype == 'WINDOWS' and $localewincharset = get_string('localewincharset', 'langconfig')) {
$format = textlib::convert($format, 'utf-8', $localewincharset);
$datestring = strftime($format, $date);
$datestring = textlib::convert($datestring, $localewincharset, 'utf-8');
} else {
$datestring = strftime($format, $date);
}
} else {
if ($CFG->ostype == 'WINDOWS' and $localewincharset = get_string('localewincharset', 'langconfig')) {
$format = textlib::convert($format, 'utf-8', $localewincharset);
$datestring = gmstrftime($format, $date);
$datestring = textlib::convert($datestring, $localewincharset, 'utf-8');
} else {
$datestring = gmstrftime($format, $date);
}
}
return $datestring;
}
/**
* Given a $time timestamp in GMT (seconds since epoch),
* returns an array that represents the date in user time
*
* @package core
* @category time
* @uses HOURSECS
* @param int $time Timestamp in GMT
* @param float|int|string $timezone offset's time with timezone, if float and not 99, then no
* dst offset is applyed {@link http://docs.moodle.org/dev/Time_API#Timezone}
* @return array An array that represents the date in user time
*/
function usergetdate($time, $timezone=99) {
//save input timezone, required for dst offset check.
$passedtimezone = $timezone;
$timezone = get_user_timezone_offset($timezone);
if (abs($timezone) > 13) { // Server time
return getdate($time);
}
//add daylight saving offset for string timezones only, as we can't get dst for
//float values. if timezone is 99 (user default timezone), then try update dst.
if ($passedtimezone == 99 || !is_numeric($passedtimezone)) {
$time += dst_offset_on($time, $passedtimezone);
}
$time += intval((float)$timezone * HOURSECS);
$datestring = gmstrftime('%B_%A_%j_%Y_%m_%w_%d_%H_%M_%S', $time);
//be careful to ensure the returned array matches that produced by getdate() above
list(
$getdate['month'],
$getdate['weekday'],
$getdate['yday'],
$getdate['year'],
$getdate['mon'],
$getdate['wday'],
$getdate['mday'],
$getdate['hours'],
$getdate['minutes'],
$getdate['seconds']
) = explode('_', $datestring);
// set correct datatype to match with getdate()
$getdate['seconds'] = (int)$getdate['seconds'];
$getdate['yday'] = (int)$getdate['yday'] - 1; // gettime returns 0 through 365
$getdate['year'] = (int)$getdate['year'];
$getdate['mon'] = (int)$getdate['mon'];
$getdate['wday'] = (int)$getdate['wday'];
$getdate['mday'] = (int)$getdate['mday'];
$getdate['hours'] = (int)$getdate['hours'];
$getdate['minutes'] = (int)$getdate['minutes'];
return $getdate;
}
/**
* Given a GMT timestamp (seconds since epoch), offsets it by
* the timezone. eg 3pm in India is 3pm GMT - 7 * 3600 seconds
*
* @package core
* @category time
* @uses HOURSECS
* @param int $date Timestamp in GMT
* @param float|int|string $timezone timezone to calculate GMT time offset before
* calculating user time, 99 is default user timezone
* {@link http://docs.moodle.org/dev/Time_API#Timezone}
* @return int
*/
function usertime($date, $timezone=99) {
$timezone = get_user_timezone_offset($timezone);
if (abs($timezone) > 13) {
return $date;
}
return $date - (int)($timezone * HOURSECS);
}
/**
* Given a time, return the GMT timestamp of the most recent midnight
* for the current user.
*
* @package core
* @category time
* @param int $date Timestamp in GMT
* @param float|int|string $timezone timezone to calculate GMT time offset before
* calculating user midnight time, 99 is default user timezone
* {@link http://docs.moodle.org/dev/Time_API#Timezone}
* @return int Returns a GMT timestamp
*/
function usergetmidnight($date, $timezone=99) {
$userdate = usergetdate($date, $timezone);
// Time of midnight of this user's day, in GMT
return make_timestamp($userdate['year'], $userdate['mon'], $userdate['mday'], 0, 0, 0, $timezone);
}
/**
* Returns a string that prints the user's timezone
*
* @package core
* @category time
* @param float|int|string $timezone timezone to calculate GMT time offset before
* calculating user timezone, 99 is default user timezone
* {@link http://docs.moodle.org/dev/Time_API#Timezone}
* @return string
*/
function usertimezone($timezone=99) {
$tz = get_user_timezone($timezone);
if (!is_float($tz)) {
return $tz;
}
if(abs($tz) > 13) { // Server time
return get_string('serverlocaltime');
}
if($tz == intval($tz)) {
// Don't show .0 for whole hours
$tz = intval($tz);
}
if($tz == 0) {
return 'UTC';
}
else if($tz > 0) {
return 'UTC+'.$tz;
}
else {
return 'UTC'.$tz;
}
}
/**
* Returns a float which represents the user's timezone difference from GMT in hours
* Checks various settings and picks the most dominant of those which have a value
*
* @package core
* @category time
* @param float|int|string $tz timezone to calculate GMT time offset for user,
* 99 is default user timezone
* {@link http://docs.moodle.org/dev/Time_API#Timezone}
* @return float
*/
function get_user_timezone_offset($tz = 99) {
global $USER, $CFG;
$tz = get_user_timezone($tz);
if (is_float($tz)) {
return $tz;
} else {
$tzrecord = get_timezone_record($tz);
if (empty($tzrecord)) {
return 99.0;
}
return (float)$tzrecord->gmtoff / HOURMINS;
}
}
/**
* Returns an int which represents the systems's timezone difference from GMT in seconds
*
* @package core
* @category time
* @param float|int|string $tz timezone for which offset is required.
* {@link http://docs.moodle.org/dev/Time_API#Timezone}
* @return int|bool if found, false is timezone 99 or error
*/
function get_timezone_offset($tz) {
global $CFG;
if ($tz == 99) {
return false;
}
if (is_numeric($tz)) {
return intval($tz * 60*60);
}
if (!$tzrecord = get_timezone_record($tz)) {
return false;
}
return intval($tzrecord->gmtoff * 60);
}
/**
* Returns a float or a string which denotes the user's timezone
* A float value means that a simple offset from GMT is used, while a string (it will be the name of a timezone in the database)
* means that for this timezone there are also DST rules to be taken into account
* Checks various settings and picks the most dominant of those which have a value
*
* @package core
* @category time
* @param float|int|string $tz timezone to calculate GMT time offset before
* calculating user timezone, 99 is default user timezone
* {@link http://docs.moodle.org/dev/Time_API#Timezone}
* @return float|string
*/
function get_user_timezone($tz = 99) {
global $USER, $CFG;
$timezones = array(
$tz,
isset($CFG->forcetimezone) ? $CFG->forcetimezone : 99,
isset($USER->timezone) ? $USER->timezone : 99,
isset($CFG->timezone) ? $CFG->timezone : 99,
);
$tz = 99;
// Loop while $tz is, empty but not zero, or 99, and there is another timezone is the array
while(((empty($tz) && !is_numeric($tz)) || $tz == 99) && $next = each($timezones)) {
$tz = $next['value'];
}
return is_numeric($tz) ? (float) $tz : $tz;
}
/**
* Returns cached timezone record for given $timezonename
*
* @package core
* @param string $timezonename name of the timezone
* @return stdClass|bool timezonerecord or false
*/
function get_timezone_record($timezonename) {
global $CFG, $DB;
static $cache = NULL;
if ($cache === NULL) {
$cache = array();
}
if (isset($cache[$timezonename])) {
return $cache[$timezonename];
}
return $cache[$timezonename] = $DB->get_record_sql('SELECT * FROM {timezone}
WHERE name = ? ORDER BY year DESC', array($timezonename), IGNORE_MULTIPLE);
}
/**
* Build and store the users Daylight Saving Time (DST) table
*
* @package core
* @param int $from_year Start year for the table, defaults to 1971
* @param int $to_year End year for the table, defaults to 2035
* @param int|float|string $strtimezone, timezone to check if dst should be applyed.
* @return bool
*/
function calculate_user_dst_table($from_year = NULL, $to_year = NULL, $strtimezone = NULL) {
global $CFG, $SESSION, $DB;
$usertz = get_user_timezone($strtimezone);
if (is_float($usertz)) {
// Trivial timezone, no DST
return false;
}
if (!empty($SESSION->dst_offsettz) && $SESSION->dst_offsettz != $usertz) {
// We have precalculated values, but the user's effective TZ has changed in the meantime, so reset
unset($SESSION->dst_offsets);
unset($SESSION->dst_range);
}
if (!empty($SESSION->dst_offsets) && empty($from_year) && empty($to_year)) {
// Repeat calls which do not request specific year ranges stop here, we have already calculated the table
// This will be the return path most of the time, pretty light computationally
return true;
}
// Reaching here means we either need to extend our table or create it from scratch
// Remember which TZ we calculated these changes for
$SESSION->dst_offsettz = $usertz;
if(empty($SESSION->dst_offsets)) {
// If we 're creating from scratch, put the two guard elements in there
$SESSION->dst_offsets = array(1 => NULL, 0 => NULL);
}
if(empty($SESSION->dst_range)) {
// If creating from scratch
$from = max((empty($from_year) ? intval(date('Y')) - 3 : $from_year), 1971);
$to = min((empty($to_year) ? intval(date('Y')) + 3 : $to_year), 2035);
// Fill in the array with the extra years we need to process
$yearstoprocess = array();
for($i = $from; $i <= $to; ++$i) {
$yearstoprocess[] = $i;
}
// Take note of which years we have processed for future calls
$SESSION->dst_range = array($from, $to);
}
else {
// If needing to extend the table, do the same
$yearstoprocess = array();
$from = max((empty($from_year) ? $SESSION->dst_range[0] : $from_year), 1971);
$to = min((empty($to_year) ? $SESSION->dst_range[1] : $to_year), 2035);
if($from < $SESSION->dst_range[0]) {
// Take note of which years we need to process and then note that we have processed them for future calls
for($i = $from; $i < $SESSION->dst_range[0]; ++$i) {
$yearstoprocess[] = $i;
}
$SESSION->dst_range[0] = $from;
}
if($to > $SESSION->dst_range[1]) {
// Take note of which years we need to process and then note that we have processed them for future calls
for($i = $SESSION->dst_range[1] + 1; $i <= $to; ++$i) {
$yearstoprocess[] = $i;
}
$SESSION->dst_range[1] = $to;
}
}
if(empty($yearstoprocess)) {
// This means that there was a call requesting a SMALLER range than we have already calculated
return true;
}
// From now on, we know that the array has at least the two guard elements, and $yearstoprocess has the years we need
// Also, the array is sorted in descending timestamp order!
// Get DB data
static $presets_cache = array();
if (!isset($presets_cache[$usertz])) {
$presets_cache[$usertz] = $DB->get_records('timezone', array('name'=>$usertz), 'year DESC', 'year, gmtoff, dstoff, dst_month, dst_startday, dst_weekday, dst_skipweeks, dst_time, std_month, std_startday, std_weekday, std_skipweeks, std_time');
}
if(empty($presets_cache[$usertz])) {
return false;
}
// Remove ending guard (first element of the array)
reset($SESSION->dst_offsets);
unset($SESSION->dst_offsets[key($SESSION->dst_offsets)]);
// Add all required change timestamps
foreach($yearstoprocess as $y) {
// Find the record which is in effect for the year $y
foreach($presets_cache[$usertz] as $year => $preset) {
if($year <= $y) {
break;
}
}
$changes = dst_changes_for_year($y, $preset);
if($changes === NULL) {
continue;
}
if($changes['dst'] != 0) {
$SESSION->dst_offsets[$changes['dst']] = $preset->dstoff * MINSECS;
}
if($changes['std'] != 0) {
$SESSION->dst_offsets[$changes['std']] = 0;
}
}
// Put in a guard element at the top
$maxtimestamp = max(array_keys($SESSION->dst_offsets));
$SESSION->dst_offsets[($maxtimestamp + DAYSECS)] = NULL; // DAYSECS is arbitrary, any "small" number will do
// Sort again
krsort($SESSION->dst_offsets);
return true;
}
/**
* Calculates the required DST change and returns a Timestamp Array
*
* @package core
* @category time
* @uses HOURSECS
* @uses MINSECS
* @param int|string $year Int or String Year to focus on
* @param object $timezone Instatiated Timezone object
* @return array|null Array dst=>xx, 0=>xx, std=>yy, 1=>yy or NULL
*/
function dst_changes_for_year($year, $timezone) {
if($timezone->dst_startday == 0 && $timezone->dst_weekday == 0 && $timezone->std_startday == 0 && $timezone->std_weekday == 0) {
return NULL;
}
$monthdaydst = find_day_in_month($timezone->dst_startday, $timezone->dst_weekday, $timezone->dst_month, $year);
$monthdaystd = find_day_in_month($timezone->std_startday, $timezone->std_weekday, $timezone->std_month, $year);
list($dst_hour, $dst_min) = explode(':', $timezone->dst_time);
list($std_hour, $std_min) = explode(':', $timezone->std_time);
$timedst = make_timestamp($year, $timezone->dst_month, $monthdaydst, 0, 0, 0, 99, false);
$timestd = make_timestamp($year, $timezone->std_month, $monthdaystd, 0, 0, 0, 99, false);
// Instead of putting hour and minute in make_timestamp(), we add them afterwards.
// This has the advantage of being able to have negative values for hour, i.e. for timezones
// where GMT time would be in the PREVIOUS day than the local one on which DST changes.
$timedst += $dst_hour * HOURSECS + $dst_min * MINSECS;
$timestd += $std_hour * HOURSECS + $std_min * MINSECS;
return array('dst' => $timedst, 0 => $timedst, 'std' => $timestd, 1 => $timestd);
}
/**
* Calculates the Daylight Saving Offset for a given date/time (timestamp)
* - Note: Daylight saving only works for string timezones and not for float.
*
* @package core
* @category time
* @param int $time must NOT be compensated at all, it has to be a pure timestamp
* @param int|float|string $strtimezone timezone for which offset is expected, if 99 or null
* then user's default timezone is used. {@link http://docs.moodle.org/dev/Time_API#Timezone}
* @return int
*/
function dst_offset_on($time, $strtimezone = NULL) {
global $SESSION;
if(!calculate_user_dst_table(NULL, NULL, $strtimezone) || empty($SESSION->dst_offsets)) {
return 0;
}
reset($SESSION->dst_offsets);
while(list($from, $offset) = each($SESSION->dst_offsets)) {
if($from <= $time) {
break;
}
}
// This is the normal return path
if($offset !== NULL) {
return $offset;
}
// Reaching this point means we haven't calculated far enough, do it now:
// Calculate extra DST changes if needed and recurse. The recursion always
// moves toward the stopping condition, so will always end.
if($from == 0) {
// We need a year smaller than $SESSION->dst_range[0]
if($SESSION->dst_range[0] == 1971) {
return 0;
}
calculate_user_dst_table($SESSION->dst_range[0] - 5, NULL, $strtimezone);
return dst_offset_on($time, $strtimezone);
}
else {
// We need a year larger than $SESSION->dst_range[1]
if($SESSION->dst_range[1] == 2035) {
return 0;
}
calculate_user_dst_table(NULL, $SESSION->dst_range[1] + 5, $strtimezone);
return dst_offset_on($time, $strtimezone);
}
}
/**
* Calculates when the day appears in specific month
*
* @package core
* @category time
* @param int $startday starting day of the month
* @param int $weekday The day when week starts (normally taken from user preferences)
* @param int $month The month whose day is sought
* @param int $year The year of the month whose day is sought
* @return int
*/
function find_day_in_month($startday, $weekday, $month, $year) {
$daysinmonth = days_in_month($month, $year);
if($weekday == -1) {
// Don't care about weekday, so return:
// abs($startday) if $startday != -1
// $daysinmonth otherwise
return ($startday == -1) ? $daysinmonth : abs($startday);
}
// From now on we 're looking for a specific weekday
// Give "end of month" its actual value, since we know it
if($startday == -1) {
$startday = -1 * $daysinmonth;
}
// Starting from day $startday, the sign is the direction
if($startday < 1) {
$startday = abs($startday);
$lastmonthweekday = strftime('%w', mktime(12, 0, 0, $month, $daysinmonth, $year));
// This is the last such weekday of the month
$lastinmonth = $daysinmonth + $weekday - $lastmonthweekday;
if($lastinmonth > $daysinmonth) {
$lastinmonth -= 7;
}
// Find the first such weekday <= $startday
while($lastinmonth > $startday) {
$lastinmonth -= 7;
}
return $lastinmonth;
}
else {
$indexweekday = strftime('%w', mktime(12, 0, 0, $month, $startday, $year));
$diff = $weekday - $indexweekday;
if($diff < 0) {
$diff += 7;
}
// This is the first such weekday of the month equal to or after $startday
$firstfromindex = $startday + $diff;
return $firstfromindex;
}
}
/**
* Calculate the number of days in a given month
*
* @package core
* @category time
* @param int $month The month whose day count is sought
* @param int $year The year of the month whose day count is sought
* @return int
*/
function days_in_month($month, $year) {
return intval(date('t', mktime(12, 0, 0, $month, 1, $year)));
}
/**
* Calculate the position in the week of a specific calendar day
*
* @package core
* @category time
* @param int $day The day of the date whose position in the week is sought
* @param int $month The month of the date whose position in the week is sought
* @param int $year The year of the date whose position in the week is sought
* @return int
*/
function dayofweek($day, $month, $year) {
// I wonder if this is any different from
// strftime('%w', mktime(12, 0, 0, $month, $daysinmonth, $year, 0));
return intval(date('w', mktime(12, 0, 0, $month, $day, $year)));
}
/// USER AUTHENTICATION AND LOGIN ////////////////////////////////////////
/**
* Returns full login url.
*
* @return string login url
*/
function get_login_url() {
global $CFG;
$url = "$CFG->wwwroot/login/index.php";
if (!empty($CFG->loginhttps)) {
$url = str_replace('http:', 'https:', $url);
}
return $url;
}
/**
* This function checks that the current user is logged in and has the
* required privileges
*
* This function checks that the current user is logged in, and optionally
* whether they are allowed to be in a particular course and view a particular
* course module.
* If they are not logged in, then it redirects them to the site login unless
* $autologinguest is set and {@link $CFG}->autologinguests is set to 1 in which
* case they are automatically logged in as guests.
* If $courseid is given and the user is not enrolled in that course then the
* user is redirected to the course enrolment page.
* If $cm is given and the course module is hidden and the user is not a teacher
* in the course then the user is redirected to the course home page.
*
* When $cm parameter specified, this function sets page layout to 'module'.
* You need to change it manually later if some other layout needed.
*
* @package core_access
* @category access
*
* @param mixed $courseorid id of the course or course object
* @param bool $autologinguest default true
* @param object $cm course module object
* @param bool $setwantsurltome Define if we want to set $SESSION->wantsurl, defaults to
* true. Used to avoid (=false) some scripts (file.php...) to set that variable,
* in order to keep redirects working properly. MDL-14495
* @param bool $preventredirect set to true in scripts that can not redirect (CLI, rss feeds, etc.), throws exceptions
* @return mixed Void, exit, and die depending on path
*/
function require_login($courseorid = NULL, $autologinguest = true, $cm = NULL, $setwantsurltome = true, $preventredirect = false) {
global $CFG, $SESSION, $USER, $PAGE, $SITE, $DB, $OUTPUT;
// Must not redirect when byteserving already started.
if (!empty($_SERVER['HTTP_RANGE'])) {
$preventredirect = true;
}
// setup global $COURSE, themes, language and locale
if (!empty($courseorid)) {
if (is_object($courseorid)) {
$course = $courseorid;
} else if ($courseorid == SITEID) {
$course = clone($SITE);
} else {
$course = $DB->get_record('course', array('id' => $courseorid), '*', MUST_EXIST);
}
if ($cm) {
if ($cm->course != $course->id) {
throw new coding_exception('course and cm parameters in require_login() call do not match!!');
}
// make sure we have a $cm from get_fast_modinfo as this contains activity access details
if (!($cm instanceof cm_info)) {
// note: nearly all pages call get_fast_modinfo anyway and it does not make any
// db queries so this is not really a performance concern, however it is obviously
// better if you use get_fast_modinfo to get the cm before calling this.
$modinfo = get_fast_modinfo($course);
$cm = $modinfo->get_cm($cm->id);
}
$PAGE->set_cm($cm, $course); // set's up global $COURSE
$PAGE->set_pagelayout('incourse');
} else {
$PAGE->set_course($course); // set's up global $COURSE
}
} else {
// do not touch global $COURSE via $PAGE->set_course(),
// the reasons is we need to be able to call require_login() at any time!!
$course = $SITE;
if ($cm) {
throw new coding_exception('cm parameter in require_login() requires valid course parameter!');
}
}
// If this is an AJAX request and $setwantsurltome is true then we need to override it and set it to false.
// Otherwise the AJAX request URL will be set to $SESSION->wantsurl and events such as self enrolment in the future
// risk leading the user back to the AJAX request URL.
if ($setwantsurltome && defined('AJAX_SCRIPT') && AJAX_SCRIPT) {
$setwantsurltome = false;
}
// Redirect to the login page if session has expired, only with dbsessions enabled (MDL-35029) to maintain current behaviour.
if ((!isloggedin() or isguestuser()) && !empty($SESSION->has_timed_out) && !$preventredirect && !empty($CFG->dbsessions)) {
if ($setwantsurltome) {
$SESSION->wantsurl = qualified_me();
}
redirect(get_login_url());
}
// If the user is not even logged in yet then make sure they are
if (!isloggedin()) {
if ($autologinguest and !empty($CFG->guestloginbutton) and !empty($CFG->autologinguests)) {
if (!$guest = get_complete_user_data('id', $CFG->siteguest)) {
// misconfigured site guest, just redirect to login page
redirect(get_login_url());
exit; // never reached
}
$lang = isset($SESSION->lang) ? $SESSION->lang : $CFG->lang;
complete_user_login($guest);
$USER->autologinguest = true;
$SESSION->lang = $lang;
} else {
//NOTE: $USER->site check was obsoleted by session test cookie,
// $USER->confirmed test is in login/index.php
if ($preventredirect) {
throw new require_login_exception('You are not logged in');
}
if ($setwantsurltome) {
$SESSION->wantsurl = qualified_me();
}
if (!empty($_SERVER['HTTP_REFERER'])) {
$SESSION->fromurl = $_SERVER['HTTP_REFERER'];
}
redirect(get_login_url());
exit; // never reached
}
}
// loginas as redirection if needed
if ($course->id != SITEID and session_is_loggedinas()) {
if ($USER->loginascontext->contextlevel == CONTEXT_COURSE) {
if ($USER->loginascontext->instanceid != $course->id) {
print_error('loginasonecourse', '', $CFG->wwwroot.'/course/view.php?id='.$USER->loginascontext->instanceid);
}
}
}
// check whether the user should be changing password (but only if it is REALLY them)
if (get_user_preferences('auth_forcepasswordchange') && !session_is_loggedinas()) {
$userauth = get_auth_plugin($USER->auth);
if ($userauth->can_change_password() and !$preventredirect) {
if ($setwantsurltome) {
$SESSION->wantsurl = qualified_me();
}
if ($changeurl = $userauth->change_password_url()) {
//use plugin custom url
redirect($changeurl);
} else {
//use moodle internal method
if (empty($CFG->loginhttps)) {
redirect($CFG->wwwroot .'/login/change_password.php');
} else {
$wwwroot = str_replace('http:','https:', $CFG->wwwroot);
redirect($wwwroot .'/login/change_password.php');
}
}
} else {
print_error('nopasswordchangeforced', 'auth');
}
}
// Check that the user account is properly set up
if (user_not_fully_set_up($USER)) {
if ($preventredirect) {
throw new require_login_exception('User not fully set-up');
}
if ($setwantsurltome) {
$SESSION->wantsurl = qualified_me();
}
redirect($CFG->wwwroot .'/user/edit.php?id='. $USER->id .'&amp;course='. SITEID);
}
// Make sure the USER has a sesskey set up. Used for CSRF protection.
sesskey();
// Do not bother admins with any formalities
if (is_siteadmin()) {
//set accesstime or the user will appear offline which messes up messaging
user_accesstime_log($course->id);
return;
}
// Check that the user has agreed to a site policy if there is one - do not test in case of admins
if (!$USER->policyagreed and !is_siteadmin()) {
if (!empty($CFG->sitepolicy) and !isguestuser()) {
if ($preventredirect) {
throw new require_login_exception('Policy not agreed');
}
if ($setwantsurltome) {
$SESSION->wantsurl = qualified_me();
}
redirect($CFG->wwwroot .'/user/policy.php');
} else if (!empty($CFG->sitepolicyguest) and isguestuser()) {
if ($preventredirect) {
throw new require_login_exception('Policy not agreed');
}
if ($setwantsurltome) {
$SESSION->wantsurl = qualified_me();
}
redirect($CFG->wwwroot .'/user/policy.php');
}
}
// Fetch the system context, the course context, and prefetch its child contexts
$sysctx = context_system::instance();
$coursecontext = context_course::instance($course->id, MUST_EXIST);
if ($cm) {
$cmcontext = context_module::instance($cm->id, MUST_EXIST);
} else {
$cmcontext = null;
}
// If the site is currently under maintenance, then print a message
if (!empty($CFG->maintenance_enabled) and !has_capability('moodle/site:config', $sysctx)) {
if ($preventredirect) {
throw new require_login_exception('Maintenance in progress');
}
print_maintenance_message();
}
// make sure the course itself is not hidden
if ($course->id == SITEID) {
// frontpage can not be hidden
} else {
if (is_role_switched($course->id)) {
// when switching roles ignore the hidden flag - user had to be in course to do the switch
} else {
if (!$course->visible and !has_capability('moodle/course:viewhiddencourses', $coursecontext)) {
// originally there was also test of parent category visibility,
// BUT is was very slow in complex queries involving "my courses"
// now it is also possible to simply hide all courses user is not enrolled in :-)
if ($preventredirect) {
throw new require_login_exception('Course is hidden');
}
// We need to override the navigation URL as the course won't have
// been added to the navigation and thus the navigation will mess up
// when trying to find it.
navigation_node::override_active_url(new moodle_url('/'));
notice(get_string('coursehidden'), $CFG->wwwroot .'/');
}
}
}
// is the user enrolled?
if ($course->id == SITEID) {
// everybody is enrolled on the frontpage
} else {
if (session_is_loggedinas()) {
// Make sure the REAL person can access this course first
$realuser = session_get_realuser();
if (!is_enrolled($coursecontext, $realuser->id, '', true) and !is_viewing($coursecontext, $realuser->id) and !is_siteadmin($realuser->id)) {
if ($preventredirect) {
throw new require_login_exception('Invalid course login-as access');
}
echo $OUTPUT->header();
notice(get_string('studentnotallowed', '', fullname($USER, true)), $CFG->wwwroot .'/');
}
}
$access = false;
if (is_role_switched($course->id)) {
// ok, user had to be inside this course before the switch
$access = true;
} else if (is_viewing($coursecontext, $USER)) {
// ok, no need to mess with enrol
$access = true;
} else {
if (isset($USER->enrol['enrolled'][$course->id])) {
if ($USER->enrol['enrolled'][$course->id] > time()) {
$access = true;
if (isset($USER->enrol['tempguest'][$course->id])) {
unset($USER->enrol['tempguest'][$course->id]);
remove_temp_course_roles($coursecontext);
}
} else {
//expired
unset($USER->enrol['enrolled'][$course->id]);
}
}
if (isset($USER->enrol['tempguest'][$course->id])) {
if ($USER->enrol['tempguest'][$course->id] == 0) {
$access = true;
} else if ($USER->enrol['tempguest'][$course->id] > time()) {
$access = true;
} else {
//expired
unset($USER->enrol['tempguest'][$course->id]);
remove_temp_course_roles($coursecontext);
}
}
if ($access) {
// cache ok
} else {
$until = enrol_get_enrolment_end($coursecontext->instanceid, $USER->id);
if ($until !== false) {
// active participants may always access, a timestamp in the future, 0 (always) or false.
if ($until == 0) {
$until = ENROL_MAX_TIMESTAMP;
}
$USER->enrol['enrolled'][$course->id] = $until;
$access = true;
} else {
$instances = $DB->get_records('enrol', array('courseid'=>$course->id, 'status'=>ENROL_INSTANCE_ENABLED), 'sortorder, id ASC');
$enrols = enrol_get_plugins(true);
// first ask all enabled enrol instances in course if they want to auto enrol user
foreach($instances as $instance) {
if (!isset($enrols[$instance->enrol])) {
continue;
}
// Get a duration for the enrolment, a timestamp in the future, 0 (always) or false.
$until = $enrols[$instance->enrol]->try_autoenrol($instance);
if ($until !== false) {
if ($until == 0) {
$until = ENROL_MAX_TIMESTAMP;
}
$USER->enrol['enrolled'][$course->id] = $until;
$access = true;
break;
}
}
// if not enrolled yet try to gain temporary guest access
if (!$access) {
foreach($instances as $instance) {
if (!isset($enrols[$instance->enrol])) {
continue;
}
// Get a duration for the guest access, a timestamp in the future or false.
$until = $enrols[$instance->enrol]->try_guestaccess($instance);
if ($until !== false and $until > time()) {
$USER->enrol['tempguest'][$course->id] = $until;
$access = true;
break;
}
}
}
}
}
}
if (!$access) {
if ($preventredirect) {
throw new require_login_exception('Not enrolled');
}
if ($setwantsurltome) {
$SESSION->wantsurl = qualified_me();
}
redirect($CFG->wwwroot .'/enrol/index.php?id='. $course->id);
}
}
// Check visibility of activity to current user; includes visible flag, groupmembersonly,
// conditional availability, etc
if ($cm && !$cm->uservisible) {
if ($preventredirect) {
throw new require_login_exception('Activity is hidden');
}
if ($course->id != SITEID) {
$url = new moodle_url('/course/view.php', array('id'=>$course->id));
} else {
$url = new moodle_url('/');
}
redirect($url, get_string('activityiscurrentlyhidden'));
}
// Finally access granted, update lastaccess times
user_accesstime_log($course->id);
}
/**
* This function just makes sure a user is logged out.
*
* @package core_access
*/
function require_logout() {
global $USER;
$params = $USER;
if (isloggedin()) {
add_to_log(SITEID, "user", "logout", "view.php?id=$USER->id&course=".SITEID, $USER->id, 0, $USER->id);
$authsequence = get_enabled_auth_plugins(); // auths, in sequence
foreach($authsequence as $authname) {
$authplugin = get_auth_plugin($authname);
$authplugin->prelogout_hook();
}
}
events_trigger('user_logout', $params);
session_get_instance()->terminate_current();
unset($params);
}
/**
* Weaker version of require_login()
*
* This is a weaker version of {@link require_login()} which only requires login
* when called from within a course rather than the site page, unless
* the forcelogin option is turned on.
* @see require_login()
*
* @package core_access
* @category access
*
* @param mixed $courseorid The course object or id in question
* @param bool $autologinguest Allow autologin guests if that is wanted
* @param object $cm Course activity module if known
* @param bool $setwantsurltome Define if we want to set $SESSION->wantsurl, defaults to
* true. Used to avoid (=false) some scripts (file.php...) to set that variable,
* in order to keep redirects working properly. MDL-14495
* @param bool $preventredirect set to true in scripts that can not redirect (CLI, rss feeds, etc.), throws exceptions
* @return void
*/
function require_course_login($courseorid, $autologinguest = true, $cm = NULL, $setwantsurltome = true, $preventredirect = false) {
global $CFG, $PAGE, $SITE;
$issite = (is_object($courseorid) and $courseorid->id == SITEID)
or (!is_object($courseorid) and $courseorid == SITEID);
if ($issite && !empty($cm) && !($cm instanceof cm_info)) {
// note: nearly all pages call get_fast_modinfo anyway and it does not make any
// db queries so this is not really a performance concern, however it is obviously
// better if you use get_fast_modinfo to get the cm before calling this.
if (is_object($courseorid)) {
$course = $courseorid;
} else {
$course = clone($SITE);
}
$modinfo = get_fast_modinfo($course);
$cm = $modinfo->get_cm($cm->id);
}
if (!empty($CFG->forcelogin)) {
// login required for both SITE and courses
require_login($courseorid, $autologinguest, $cm, $setwantsurltome, $preventredirect);
} else if ($issite && !empty($cm) and !$cm->uservisible) {
// always login for hidden activities
require_login($courseorid, $autologinguest, $cm, $setwantsurltome, $preventredirect);
} else if ($issite) {
//login for SITE not required
if ($cm and empty($cm->visible)) {
// hidden activities are not accessible without login
require_login($courseorid, $autologinguest, $cm, $setwantsurltome, $preventredirect);
} else if ($cm and !empty($CFG->enablegroupmembersonly) and $cm->groupmembersonly) {
// not-logged-in users do not have any group membership
require_login($courseorid, $autologinguest, $cm, $setwantsurltome, $preventredirect);
} else {
// We still need to instatiate PAGE vars properly so that things
// that rely on it like navigation function correctly.
if (!empty($courseorid)) {
if (is_object($courseorid)) {
$course = $courseorid;
} else {
$course = clone($SITE);
}
if ($cm) {
if ($cm->course != $course->id) {
throw new coding_exception('course and cm parameters in require_course_login() call do not match!!');
}
$PAGE->set_cm($cm, $course);
$PAGE->set_pagelayout('incourse');
} else {
$PAGE->set_course($course);
}
} else {
// If $PAGE->course, and hence $PAGE->context, have not already been set
// up properly, set them up now.
$PAGE->set_course($PAGE->course);
}
//TODO: verify conditional activities here
user_accesstime_log(SITEID);
return;
}
} else {
// course login always required
require_login($courseorid, $autologinguest, $cm, $setwantsurltome, $preventredirect);
}
}
/**
* Require key login. Function terminates with error if key not found or incorrect.
*
* @global object
* @global object
* @global object
* @global object
* @uses NO_MOODLE_COOKIES
* @uses PARAM_ALPHANUM
* @param string $script unique script identifier
* @param int $instance optional instance id
* @return int Instance ID
*/
function require_user_key_login($script, $instance=null) {
global $USER, $SESSION, $CFG, $DB;
if (!NO_MOODLE_COOKIES) {
print_error('sessioncookiesdisable');
}
/// extra safety
@session_write_close();
$keyvalue = required_param('key', PARAM_ALPHANUM);
if (!$key = $DB->get_record('user_private_key', array('script'=>$script, 'value'=>$keyvalue, 'instance'=>$instance))) {
print_error('invalidkey');
}
if (!empty($key->validuntil) and $key->validuntil < time()) {
print_error('expiredkey');
}
if ($key->iprestriction) {
$remoteaddr = getremoteaddr(null);
if (empty($remoteaddr) or !address_in_subnet($remoteaddr, $key->iprestriction)) {
print_error('ipmismatch');
}
}
if (!$user = $DB->get_record('user', array('id'=>$key->userid))) {
print_error('invaliduserid');
}
/// emulate normal session
enrol_check_plugins($user);
session_set_user($user);
/// note we are not using normal login
if (!defined('USER_KEY_LOGIN')) {
define('USER_KEY_LOGIN', true);
}
/// return instance id - it might be empty
return $key->instance;
}
/**
* Creates a new private user access key.
*
* @global object
* @param string $script unique target identifier
* @param int $userid
* @param int $instance optional instance id
* @param string $iprestriction optional ip restricted access
* @param timestamp $validuntil key valid only until given data
* @return string access key value
*/
function create_user_key($script, $userid, $instance=null, $iprestriction=null, $validuntil=null) {
global $DB;
$key = new stdClass();
$key->script = $script;
$key->userid = $userid;
$key->instance = $instance;
$key->iprestriction = $iprestriction;
$key->validuntil = $validuntil;
$key->timecreated = time();
$key->value = md5($userid.'_'.time().random_string(40)); // something long and unique
while ($DB->record_exists('user_private_key', array('value'=>$key->value))) {
// must be unique
$key->value = md5($userid.'_'.time().random_string(40));
}
$DB->insert_record('user_private_key', $key);
return $key->value;
}
/**
* Delete the user's new private user access keys for a particular script.
*
* @global object
* @param string $script unique target identifier
* @param int $userid
* @return void
*/
function delete_user_key($script,$userid) {
global $DB;
$DB->delete_records('user_private_key', array('script'=>$script, 'userid'=>$userid));
}
/**
* Gets a private user access key (and creates one if one doesn't exist).
*
* @global object
* @param string $script unique target identifier
* @param int $userid
* @param int $instance optional instance id
* @param string $iprestriction optional ip restricted access
* @param timestamp $validuntil key valid only until given data
* @return string access key value
*/
function get_user_key($script, $userid, $instance=null, $iprestriction=null, $validuntil=null) {
global $DB;
if ($key = $DB->get_record('user_private_key', array('script'=>$script, 'userid'=>$userid,
'instance'=>$instance, 'iprestriction'=>$iprestriction,
'validuntil'=>$validuntil))) {
return $key->value;
} else {
return create_user_key($script, $userid, $instance, $iprestriction, $validuntil);
}
}
/**
* Modify the user table by setting the currently logged in user's
* last login to now.
*
* @global object
* @global object
* @return bool Always returns true
*/
function update_user_login_times() {
global $USER, $DB;
if (isguestuser()) {
// Do not update guest access times/ips for performance.
return true;
}
$now = time();
$user = new stdClass();
$user->id = $USER->id;
// Make sure all users that logged in have some firstaccess.
if ($USER->firstaccess == 0) {
$USER->firstaccess = $user->firstaccess = $now;
}
// Store the previous current as lastlogin.
$USER->lastlogin = $user->lastlogin = $USER->currentlogin;
$USER->currentlogin = $user->currentlogin = $now;
// Function user_accesstime_log() may not update immediately, better do it here.
$USER->lastaccess = $user->lastaccess = $now;
$USER->lastip = $user->lastip = getremoteaddr();
$DB->update_record('user', $user);
return true;
}
/**
* Determines if a user has completed setting up their account.
*
* @param user $user A {@link $USER} object to test for the existence of a valid name and email
* @return bool
*/
function user_not_fully_set_up($user) {
if (isguestuser($user)) {
return false;
}
return (empty($user->firstname) or empty($user->lastname) or empty($user->email) or over_bounce_threshold($user));
}
/**
* Check whether the user has exceeded the bounce threshold
*
* @global object
* @global object
* @param user $user A {@link $USER} object
* @return bool true=>User has exceeded bounce threshold
*/
function over_bounce_threshold($user) {
global $CFG, $DB;
if (empty($CFG->handlebounces)) {
return false;
}
if (empty($user->id)) { /// No real (DB) user, nothing to do here.
return false;
}
// set sensible defaults
if (empty($CFG->minbounces)) {
$CFG->minbounces = 10;
}
if (empty($CFG->bounceratio)) {
$CFG->bounceratio = .20;
}
$bouncecount = 0;
$sendcount = 0;
if ($bounce = $DB->get_record('user_preferences', array ('userid'=>$user->id, 'name'=>'email_bounce_count'))) {
$bouncecount = $bounce->value;
}
if ($send = $DB->get_record('user_preferences', array('userid'=>$user->id, 'name'=>'email_send_count'))) {
$sendcount = $send->value;
}
return ($bouncecount >= $CFG->minbounces && $bouncecount/$sendcount >= $CFG->bounceratio);
}
/**
* Used to increment or reset email sent count
*
* @global object
* @param user $user object containing an id
* @param bool $reset will reset the count to 0
* @return void
*/
function set_send_count($user,$reset=false) {
global $DB;
if (empty($user->id)) { /// No real (DB) user, nothing to do here.
return;
}
if ($pref = $DB->get_record('user_preferences', array('userid'=>$user->id, 'name'=>'email_send_count'))) {
$pref->value = (!empty($reset)) ? 0 : $pref->value+1;
$DB->update_record('user_preferences', $pref);
}
else if (!empty($reset)) { // if it's not there and we're resetting, don't bother.
// make a new one
$pref = new stdClass();
$pref->name = 'email_send_count';
$pref->value = 1;
$pref->userid = $user->id;
$DB->insert_record('user_preferences', $pref, false);
}
}
/**
* Increment or reset user's email bounce count
*
* @global object
* @param user $user object containing an id
* @param bool $reset will reset the count to 0
*/
function set_bounce_count($user,$reset=false) {
global $DB;
if ($pref = $DB->get_record('user_preferences', array('userid'=>$user->id, 'name'=>'email_bounce_count'))) {
$pref->value = (!empty($reset)) ? 0 : $pref->value+1;
$DB->update_record('user_preferences', $pref);
}
else if (!empty($reset)) { // if it's not there and we're resetting, don't bother.
// make a new one
$pref = new stdClass();
$pref->name = 'email_bounce_count';
$pref->value = 1;
$pref->userid = $user->id;
$DB->insert_record('user_preferences', $pref, false);
}
}
/**
* Determines if the currently logged in user is in editing mode.
* Note: originally this function had $userid parameter - it was not usable anyway
*
* @deprecated since Moodle 2.0 - use $PAGE->user_is_editing() instead.
* @todo Deprecated function remove when ready
*
* @global object
* @uses DEBUG_DEVELOPER
* @return bool
*/
function isediting() {
global $PAGE;
debugging('call to deprecated function isediting(). Please use $PAGE->user_is_editing() instead', DEBUG_DEVELOPER);
return $PAGE->user_is_editing();
}
/**
* Determines if the logged in user is currently moving an activity
*
* @global object
* @param int $courseid The id of the course being tested
* @return bool
*/
function ismoving($courseid) {
global $USER;
if (!empty($USER->activitycopy)) {
return ($USER->activitycopycourse == $courseid);
}
return false;
}
/**
* Returns a persons full name
*
* Given an object containing firstname and lastname
* values, this function returns a string with the
* full name of the person.
* The result may depend on system settings
* or language. 'override' will force both names
* to be used even if system settings specify one.
*
* @global object
* @global object
* @param object $user A {@link $USER} object to get full name of
* @param bool $override If true then the name will be first name followed by last name rather than adhering to fullnamedisplay setting.
* @return string
*/
function fullname($user, $override=false) {
global $CFG, $SESSION;
if (!isset($user->firstname) and !isset($user->lastname)) {
return '';
}
if (!$override) {
if (!empty($CFG->forcefirstname)) {
$user->firstname = $CFG->forcefirstname;
}
if (!empty($CFG->forcelastname)) {
$user->lastname = $CFG->forcelastname;
}
}
if (!empty($SESSION->fullnamedisplay)) {
$CFG->fullnamedisplay = $SESSION->fullnamedisplay;
}
if (!isset($CFG->fullnamedisplay) or $CFG->fullnamedisplay === 'firstname lastname') {
return $user->firstname .' '. $user->lastname;
} else if ($CFG->fullnamedisplay == 'lastname firstname') {
return $user->lastname .' '. $user->firstname;
} else if ($CFG->fullnamedisplay == 'firstname') {
if ($override) {
return get_string('fullnamedisplay', '', $user);
} else {
return $user->firstname;
}
}
return get_string('fullnamedisplay', '', $user);
}
/**
* Checks if current user is shown any extra fields when listing users.
* @param object $context Context
* @param array $already Array of fields that we're going to show anyway
* so don't bother listing them
* @return array Array of field names from user table, not including anything
* listed in $already
*/
function get_extra_user_fields($context, $already = array()) {
global $CFG;
// Only users with permission get the extra fields
if (!has_capability('moodle/site:viewuseridentity', $context)) {
return array();
}
// Split showuseridentity on comma
if (empty($CFG->showuseridentity)) {
// Explode gives wrong result with empty string
$extra = array();
} else {
$extra = explode(',', $CFG->showuseridentity);
}
$renumber = false;
foreach ($extra as $key => $field) {
if (in_array($field, $already)) {
unset($extra[$key]);
$renumber = true;
}
}
if ($renumber) {
// For consistency, if entries are removed from array, renumber it
// so they are numbered as you would expect
$extra = array_merge($extra);
}
return $extra;
}
/**
* If the current user is to be shown extra user fields when listing or
* selecting users, returns a string suitable for including in an SQL select
* clause to retrieve those fields.
* @param object $context Context
* @param string $alias Alias of user table, e.g. 'u' (default none)
* @param string $prefix Prefix for field names using AS, e.g. 'u_' (default none)
* @param array $already Array of fields that we're going to include anyway
* so don't list them (default none)
* @return string Partial SQL select clause, beginning with comma, for example
* ',u.idnumber,u.department' unless it is blank
*/
function get_extra_user_fields_sql($context, $alias='', $prefix='',
$already = array()) {
$fields = get_extra_user_fields($context, $already);
$result = '';
// Add punctuation for alias
if ($alias !== '') {
$alias .= '.';
}
foreach ($fields as $field) {
$result .= ', ' . $alias . $field;
if ($prefix) {
$result .= ' AS ' . $prefix . $field;
}
}
return $result;
}
/**
* Returns the display name of a field in the user table. Works for most fields
* that are commonly displayed to users.
* @param string $field Field name, e.g. 'phone1'
* @return string Text description taken from language file, e.g. 'Phone number'
*/
function get_user_field_name($field) {
// Some fields have language strings which are not the same as field name
switch ($field) {
case 'phone1' : return get_string('phone');
case 'url' : return get_string('webpage');
case 'icq' : return get_string('icqnumber');
case 'skype' : return get_string('skypeid');
case 'aim' : return get_string('aimid');
case 'yahoo' : return get_string('yahooid');
case 'msn' : return get_string('msnid');
}
// Otherwise just use the same lang string
return get_string($field);
}
/**
* Returns whether a given authentication plugin exists.
*
* @global object
* @param string $auth Form of authentication to check for. Defaults to the
* global setting in {@link $CFG}.
* @return boolean Whether the plugin is available.
*/
function exists_auth_plugin($auth) {
global $CFG;
if (file_exists("{$CFG->dirroot}/auth/$auth/auth.php")) {
return is_readable("{$CFG->dirroot}/auth/$auth/auth.php");
}
return false;
}
/**
* Checks if a given plugin is in the list of enabled authentication plugins.
*
* @param string $auth Authentication plugin.
* @return boolean Whether the plugin is enabled.
*/
function is_enabled_auth($auth) {
if (empty($auth)) {
return false;
}
$enabled = get_enabled_auth_plugins();
return in_array($auth, $enabled);
}
/**
* Returns an authentication plugin instance.
*
* @global object
* @param string $auth name of authentication plugin
* @return auth_plugin_base An instance of the required authentication plugin.
*/
function get_auth_plugin($auth) {
global $CFG;
// check the plugin exists first
if (! exists_auth_plugin($auth)) {
print_error('authpluginnotfound', 'debug', '', $auth);
}
// return auth plugin instance
require_once "{$CFG->dirroot}/auth/$auth/auth.php";
$class = "auth_plugin_$auth";
return new $class;
}
/**
* Returns array of active auth plugins.
*
* @param bool $fix fix $CFG->auth if needed
* @return array
*/
function get_enabled_auth_plugins($fix=false) {
global $CFG;
$default = array('manual', 'nologin');
if (empty($CFG->auth)) {
$auths = array();
} else {
$auths = explode(',', $CFG->auth);
}
if ($fix) {
$auths = array_unique($auths);
foreach($auths as $k=>$authname) {
if (!exists_auth_plugin($authname) or in_array($authname, $default)) {
unset($auths[$k]);
}
}
$newconfig = implode(',', $auths);
if (!isset($CFG->auth) or $newconfig != $CFG->auth) {
set_config('auth', $newconfig);
}
}
return (array_merge($default, $auths));
}
/**
* Returns true if an internal authentication method is being used.
* if method not specified then, global default is assumed
*
* @param string $auth Form of authentication required
* @return bool
*/
function is_internal_auth($auth) {
$authplugin = get_auth_plugin($auth); // throws error if bad $auth
return $authplugin->is_internal();
}
/**
* Returns true if the user is a 'restored' one
*
* Used in the login process to inform the user
* and allow him/her to reset the password
*
* @uses $CFG
* @uses $DB
* @param string $username username to be checked
* @return bool
*/
function is_restored_user($username) {
global $CFG, $DB;
return $DB->record_exists('user', array('username'=>$username, 'mnethostid'=>$CFG->mnet_localhost_id, 'password'=>'restored'));
}
/**
* Returns an array of user fields
*
* @return array User field/column names
*/
function get_user_fieldnames() {
global $DB;
$fieldarray = $DB->get_columns('user');
unset($fieldarray['id']);
$fieldarray = array_keys($fieldarray);
return $fieldarray;
}
/**
* Creates a bare-bones user record
*
* @todo Outline auth types and provide code example
*
* @param string $username New user's username to add to record
* @param string $password New user's password to add to record
* @param string $auth Form of authentication required
* @return stdClass A complete user object
*/
function create_user_record($username, $password, $auth = 'manual') {
global $CFG, $DB;
//just in case check text case
$username = trim(textlib::strtolower($username));
$authplugin = get_auth_plugin($auth);
$newuser = new stdClass();
if ($newinfo = $authplugin->get_userinfo($username)) {
$newinfo = truncate_userinfo($newinfo);
foreach ($newinfo as $key => $value){
$newuser->$key = $value;
}
}
if (!empty($newuser->email)) {
if (email_is_not_allowed($newuser->email)) {
unset($newuser->email);
}
}
if (!isset($newuser->city)) {
$newuser->city = '';
}
$newuser->auth = $auth;
$newuser->username = $username;
// fix for MDL-8480
// user CFG lang for user if $newuser->lang is empty
// or $user->lang is not an installed language
if (empty($newuser->lang) || !get_string_manager()->translation_exists($newuser->lang)) {
$newuser->lang = $CFG->lang;
}
$newuser->confirmed = 1;
$newuser->lastip = getremoteaddr();
$newuser->timecreated = time();
$newuser->timemodified = $newuser->timecreated;
$newuser->mnethostid = $CFG->mnet_localhost_id;
$newuser->id = $DB->insert_record('user', $newuser);
$user = get_complete_user_data('id', $newuser->id);
if (!empty($CFG->{'auth_'.$newuser->auth.'_forcechangepassword'})){
set_user_preference('auth_forcepasswordchange', 1, $user);
}
// Set the password.
update_internal_user_password($user, $password);
// fetch full user record for the event, the complete user data contains too much info
// and we want to be consistent with other places that trigger this event
events_trigger('user_created', $DB->get_record('user', array('id'=>$user->id)));
return $user;
}
/**
* Will update a local user record from an external source.
* (MNET users can not be updated using this method!)
*
* @param string $username user's username to update the record
* @return stdClass A complete user object
*/
function update_user_record($username) {
global $DB, $CFG;
$username = trim(textlib::strtolower($username)); /// just in case check text case
$oldinfo = $DB->get_record('user', array('username'=>$username, 'mnethostid'=>$CFG->mnet_localhost_id), '*', MUST_EXIST);
$newuser = array();
$userauth = get_auth_plugin($oldinfo->auth);
if ($newinfo = $userauth->get_userinfo($username)) {
$newinfo = truncate_userinfo($newinfo);
foreach ($newinfo as $key => $value){
$key = strtolower($key);
if (!property_exists($oldinfo, $key) or $key === 'username' or $key === 'id'
or $key === 'auth' or $key === 'mnethostid' or $key === 'deleted') {
// unknown or must not be changed
continue;
}
$confval = $userauth->config->{'field_updatelocal_' . $key};
$lockval = $userauth->config->{'field_lock_' . $key};
if (empty($confval) || empty($lockval)) {
continue;
}
if ($confval === 'onlogin') {
// MDL-4207 Don't overwrite modified user profile values with
// empty LDAP values when 'unlocked if empty' is set. The purpose
// of the setting 'unlocked if empty' is to allow the user to fill
// in a value for the selected field _if LDAP is giving
// nothing_ for this field. Thus it makes sense to let this value
// stand in until LDAP is giving a value for this field.
if (!(empty($value) && $lockval === 'unlockedifempty')) {
if ((string)$oldinfo->$key !== (string)$value) {
$newuser[$key] = (string)$value;
}
}
}
}
if ($newuser) {
$newuser['id'] = $oldinfo->id;
$newuser['timemodified'] = time();
$DB->update_record('user', $newuser);
// fetch full user record for the event, the complete user data contains too much info
// and we want to be consistent with other places that trigger this event
events_trigger('user_updated', $DB->get_record('user', array('id'=>$oldinfo->id)));
}
}
return get_complete_user_data('id', $oldinfo->id);
}
/**
* Will truncate userinfo as it comes from auth_get_userinfo (from external auth)
* which may have large fields
*
* @todo Add vartype handling to ensure $info is an array
*
* @param array $info Array of user properties to truncate if needed
* @return array The now truncated information that was passed in
*/
function truncate_userinfo($info) {
// define the limits
$limit = array(
'username' => 100,
'idnumber' => 255,
'firstname' => 100,
'lastname' => 100,
'email' => 100,
'icq' => 15,
'phone1' => 20,
'phone2' => 20,
'institution' => 40,
'department' => 30,
'address' => 70,
'city' => 120,
'country' => 2,
'url' => 255,
);
// apply where needed
foreach (array_keys($info) as $key) {
if (!empty($limit[$key])) {
$info[$key] = trim(textlib::substr($info[$key],0, $limit[$key]));
}
}
return $info;
}
/**
* Marks user deleted in internal user database and notifies the auth plugin.
* Also unenrols user from all roles and does other cleanup.
*
* Any plugin that needs to purge user data should register the 'user_deleted' event.
*
* @param stdClass $user full user object before delete
* @return boolean success
* @throws coding_exception if invalid $user parameter detected
*/
function delete_user(stdClass $user) {
global $CFG, $DB;
require_once($CFG->libdir.'/grouplib.php');
require_once($CFG->libdir.'/gradelib.php');
require_once($CFG->dirroot.'/message/lib.php');
require_once($CFG->dirroot.'/tag/lib.php');
// Make sure nobody sends bogus record type as parameter.
if (!property_exists($user, 'id') or !property_exists($user, 'username')) {
throw new coding_exception('Invalid $user parameter in delete_user() detected');
}
// Better not trust the parameter and fetch the latest info,
// this will be very expensive anyway.
if (!$user = $DB->get_record('user', array('id'=>$user->id))) {
debugging('Attempt to delete unknown user account.');
return false;
}
// There must be always exactly one guest record,
// originally the guest account was identified by username only,
// now we use $CFG->siteguest for performance reasons.
if ($user->username === 'guest' or isguestuser($user)) {
debugging('Guest user account can not be deleted.');
return false;
}
// Admin can be theoretically from different auth plugin,
// but we want to prevent deletion of internal accoutns only,
// if anything goes wrong ppl may force somebody to be admin via
// config.php setting $CFG->siteadmins.
if ($user->auth === 'manual' and is_siteadmin($user)) {
debugging('Local administrator accounts can not be deleted.');
return false;
}
// delete all grades - backup is kept in grade_grades_history table
grade_user_delete($user->id);
//move unread messages from this user to read
message_move_userfrom_unread2read($user->id);
// TODO: remove from cohorts using standard API here
// remove user tags
tag_set('user', $user->id, array());
// unconditionally unenrol from all courses
enrol_user_delete($user);
// unenrol from all roles in all contexts
role_unassign_all(array('userid'=>$user->id)); // this might be slow but it is really needed - modules might do some extra cleanup!
//now do a brute force cleanup
// remove from all cohorts
$DB->delete_records('cohort_members', array('userid'=>$user->id));
// remove from all groups
$DB->delete_records('groups_members', array('userid'=>$user->id));
// brute force unenrol from all courses
$DB->delete_records('user_enrolments', array('userid'=>$user->id));
// purge user preferences
$DB->delete_records('user_preferences', array('userid'=>$user->id));
// purge user extra profile info
$DB->delete_records('user_info_data', array('userid'=>$user->id));
// last course access not necessary either
$DB->delete_records('user_lastaccess', array('userid'=>$user->id));
// remove all user tokens
$DB->delete_records('external_tokens', array('userid'=>$user->id));
// unauthorise the user for all services
$DB->delete_records('external_services_users', array('userid'=>$user->id));
// force logout - may fail if file based sessions used, sorry
session_kill_user($user->id);
// now do a final accesslib cleanup - removes all role assignments in user context and context itself
delete_context(CONTEXT_USER, $user->id);
// workaround for bulk deletes of users with the same email address
$delname = "$user->email.".time();
while ($DB->record_exists('user', array('username'=>$delname))) { // no need to use mnethostid here
$delname++;
}
// mark internal user record as "deleted"
$updateuser = new stdClass();
$updateuser->id = $user->id;
$updateuser->deleted = 1;
$updateuser->username = $delname; // Remember it just in case
$updateuser->email = md5($user->username);// Store hash of username, useful importing/restoring users
$updateuser->idnumber = ''; // Clear this field to free it up
$updateuser->picture = 0;
$updateuser->timemodified = time();
$DB->update_record('user', $updateuser);
// Add this action to log
add_to_log(SITEID, 'user', 'delete', "view.php?id=$user->id", $user->firstname.' '.$user->lastname);
// We will update the user's timemodified, as it will be passed to the user_deleted event, which
// should know about this updated property persisted to the user's table.
$user->timemodified = $updateuser->timemodified;
// notify auth plugin - do not block the delete even when plugin fails
$authplugin = get_auth_plugin($user->auth);
$authplugin->user_delete($user);
// any plugin that needs to cleanup should register this event
events_trigger('user_deleted', $user);
return true;
}
/**
* Retrieve the guest user object
*
* @global object
* @global object
* @return user A {@link $USER} object
*/
function guest_user() {
global $CFG, $DB;
if ($newuser = $DB->get_record('user', array('id'=>$CFG->siteguest))) {
$newuser->confirmed = 1;
$newuser->lang = $CFG->lang;
$newuser->lastip = getremoteaddr();
}
return $newuser;
}
/**
* Authenticates a user against the chosen authentication mechanism
*
* Given a username and password, this function looks them
* up using the currently selected authentication mechanism,
* and if the authentication is successful, it returns a
* valid $user object from the 'user' table.
*
* Uses auth_ functions from the currently active auth module
*
* After authenticate_user_login() returns success, you will need to
* log that the user has logged in, and call complete_user_login() to set
* the session up.
*
* Note: this function works only with non-mnet accounts!
*
* @param string $username User's username
* @param string $password User's password
* @param bool $ignorelockout useful when guessing is prevented by other mechanism such as captcha or SSO
* @param int $failurereason login failure reason, can be used in renderers (it may disclose if account exists)
* @return stdClass|false A {@link $USER} object or false if error
*/
function authenticate_user_login($username, $password, $ignorelockout=false, &$failurereason=null) {
global $CFG, $DB;
require_once("$CFG->libdir/authlib.php");
$authsenabled = get_enabled_auth_plugins();
if ($user = get_complete_user_data('username', $username, $CFG->mnet_localhost_id)) {
$auth = empty($user->auth) ? 'manual' : $user->auth; // use manual if auth not set
if (!empty($user->suspended)) {
add_to_log(SITEID, 'login', 'error', 'index.php', $username);
error_log('[client '.getremoteaddr()."] $CFG->wwwroot Suspended Login: $username ".$_SERVER['HTTP_USER_AGENT']);
$failurereason = AUTH_LOGIN_SUSPENDED;
return false;
}
if ($auth=='nologin' or !is_enabled_auth($auth)) {
add_to_log(SITEID, 'login', 'error', 'index.php', $username);
error_log('[client '.getremoteaddr()."] $CFG->wwwroot Disabled Login: $username ".$_SERVER['HTTP_USER_AGENT']);
$failurereason = AUTH_LOGIN_SUSPENDED; // Legacy way to suspend user.
return false;
}
$auths = array($auth);
} else {
// Check if there's a deleted record (cheaply), this should not happen because we mangle usernames in delete_user().
if ($DB->get_field('user', 'id', array('username'=>$username, 'mnethostid'=>$CFG->mnet_localhost_id, 'deleted'=>1))) {
error_log('[client '.getremoteaddr()."] $CFG->wwwroot Deleted Login: $username ".$_SERVER['HTTP_USER_AGENT']);
$failurereason = AUTH_LOGIN_NOUSER;
return false;
}
// Do not try to authenticate non-existent accounts when user creation is not disabled.
if (!empty($CFG->authpreventaccountcreation)) {
add_to_log(SITEID, 'login', 'error', 'index.php', $username);
error_log('[client '.getremoteaddr()."] $CFG->wwwroot Unknown user, can not create new accounts: $username ".$_SERVER['HTTP_USER_AGENT']);
$failurereason = AUTH_LOGIN_NOUSER;
return false;
}
// User does not exist
$auths = $authsenabled;
$user = new stdClass();
$user->id = 0;
}
if ($ignorelockout) {
// Some other mechanism protects against brute force password guessing,
// for example login form might include reCAPTCHA or this function
// is called from a SSO script.
} else if ($user->id) {
// Verify login lockout after other ways that may prevent user login.
if (login_is_lockedout($user)) {
add_to_log(SITEID, 'login', 'error', 'index.php', $username);
error_log('[client '.getremoteaddr()."] $CFG->wwwroot Login lockout: $username ".$_SERVER['HTTP_USER_AGENT']);
$failurereason = AUTH_LOGIN_LOCKOUT;
return false;
}
} else {
// We can not lockout non-existing accounts.
}
foreach ($auths as $auth) {
$authplugin = get_auth_plugin($auth);
// on auth fail fall through to the next plugin
if (!$authplugin->user_login($username, $password)) {
continue;
}
// successful authentication
if ($user->id) { // User already exists in database
if (empty($user->auth)) { // For some reason auth isn't set yet
$DB->set_field('user', 'auth', $auth, array('username'=>$username));
$user->auth = $auth;
}
// If the existing hash is using an out-of-date algorithm (or the
// legacy md5 algorithm), then we should update to the current
// hash algorithm while we have access to the user's password.
update_internal_user_password($user, $password);
if ($authplugin->is_synchronised_with_external()) { // update user record from external DB
$user = update_user_record($username);
}
} else {
// Create account, we verified above that user creation is allowed.
$user = create_user_record($username, $password, $auth);
}
$authplugin->sync_roles($user);
foreach ($authsenabled as $hau) {
$hauth = get_auth_plugin($hau);
$hauth->user_authenticated_hook($user, $username, $password);
}
if (empty($user->id)) {
$failurereason = AUTH_LOGIN_NOUSER;
return false;
}
if (!empty($user->suspended)) {
// just in case some auth plugin suspended account
add_to_log(SITEID, 'login', 'error', 'index.php', $username);
error_log('[client '.getremoteaddr()."] $CFG->wwwroot Suspended Login: $username ".$_SERVER['HTTP_USER_AGENT']);
$failurereason = AUTH_LOGIN_SUSPENDED;
return false;
}
login_attempt_valid($user);
$failurereason = AUTH_LOGIN_OK;
return $user;
}
// failed if all the plugins have failed
add_to_log(SITEID, 'login', 'error', 'index.php', $username);
if (debugging('', DEBUG_ALL)) {
error_log('[client '.getremoteaddr()."] $CFG->wwwroot Failed Login: $username ".$_SERVER['HTTP_USER_AGENT']);
}
if ($user->id) {
login_attempt_failed($user);
$failurereason = AUTH_LOGIN_FAILED;
} else {
$failurereason = AUTH_LOGIN_NOUSER;
}
return false;
}
/**
* Call to complete the user login process after authenticate_user_login()
* has succeeded. It will setup the $USER variable and other required bits
* and pieces.
*
* NOTE:
* - It will NOT log anything -- up to the caller to decide what to log.
* - this function does not set any cookies any more!
*
* @param object $user
* @return object A {@link $USER} object - BC only, do not use
*/
function complete_user_login($user) {
global $CFG, $USER;
// regenerate session id and delete old session,
// this helps prevent session fixation attacks from the same domain
session_regenerate_id(true);
// let enrol plugins deal with new enrolments if necessary
enrol_check_plugins($user);
// check enrolments, load caps and setup $USER object
session_set_user($user);
// reload preferences from DB
unset($USER->preference);
check_user_preferences_loaded($USER);
// update login times
update_user_login_times();
// extra session prefs init
set_login_session_preferences();
if (isguestuser()) {
// no need to continue when user is THE guest
return $USER;
}
/// Select password change url
$userauth = get_auth_plugin($USER->auth);
/// check whether the user should be changing password
if (get_user_preferences('auth_forcepasswordchange', false)){
if ($userauth->can_change_password()) {
if ($changeurl = $userauth->change_password_url()) {
redirect($changeurl);
} else {
redirect($CFG->httpswwwroot.'/login/change_password.php');
}
} else {
print_error('nopasswordchangeforced', 'auth');
}
}
return $USER;
}
/**
* Check a password hash to see if it was hashed using the
* legacy hash algorithm (md5).
*
* @param string $password String to check.
* @return boolean True if the $password matches the format of an md5 sum.
*/
function password_is_legacy_hash($password) {
return (bool) preg_match('/^[0-9a-f]{32}$/', $password);
}
/**
* Checks whether the password compatibility library will work with the current
* version of PHP. This cannot be done using PHP version numbers since the fix
* has been backported to earlier versions in some distributions.
*
* See https://github.com/ircmaxell/password_compat/issues/10 for
* more details.
*
* @return bool True if the library is NOT supported.
*/
function password_compat_not_supported() {
$hash = '$2y$04$usesomesillystringfore7hnbRJHxXVLeakoG8K30oukPsA.ztMG';
// Create a one off application cache to store bcrypt support status as
// the support status doesn't change and crypt() is slow.
$cache = cache::make_from_params(cache_store::MODE_APPLICATION, 'core', 'password_compat');
if (!$bcryptsupport = $cache->get('bcryptsupport')) {
$test = crypt('password', $hash);
// Cache string instead of boolean to avoid MDL-37472.
if ($test == $hash) {
$bcryptsupport = 'supported';
} else {
$bcryptsupport = 'not supported';
}
$cache->set('bcryptsupport', $bcryptsupport);
}
// Return true if bcrypt *not* supported.
return ($bcryptsupport !== 'supported');
}
/**
* Compare password against hash stored in user object to determine if it is valid.
*
* If necessary it also updates the stored hash to the current format.
*
* @param stdClass $user (Password property may be updated).
* @param string $password Plain text password.
* @return bool True if password is valid.
*/
function validate_internal_user_password($user, $password) {
global $CFG;
require_once($CFG->libdir.'/password_compat/lib/password.php');
if ($user->password === AUTH_PASSWORD_NOT_CACHED) {
// Internal password is not used at all, it can not validate.
return false;
}
// If hash isn't a legacy (md5) hash, validate using the library function.
if (!password_is_legacy_hash($user->password)) {
return password_verify($password, $user->password);
}
// Otherwise we need to check for a legacy (md5) hash instead. If the hash
// is valid we can then update it to the new algorithm.
$sitesalt = isset($CFG->passwordsaltmain) ? $CFG->passwordsaltmain : '';
$validated = false;
if ($user->password === md5($password.$sitesalt)
or $user->password === md5($password)
or $user->password === md5(addslashes($password).$sitesalt)
or $user->password === md5(addslashes($password))) {
// note: we are intentionally using the addslashes() here because we
// need to accept old password hashes of passwords with magic quotes
$validated = true;
} else {
for ($i=1; $i<=20; $i++) { //20 alternative salts should be enough, right?
$alt = 'passwordsaltalt'.$i;
if (!empty($CFG->$alt)) {
if ($user->password === md5($password.$CFG->$alt) or $user->password === md5(addslashes($password).$CFG->$alt)) {
$validated = true;
break;
}
}
}
}
if ($validated) {
// If the password matches the existing md5 hash, update to the
// current hash algorithm while we have access to the user's password.
update_internal_user_password($user, $password);
}
return $validated;
}
/**
* Calculate hash for a plain text password.
*
* @param string $password Plain text password to be hashed.
* @param bool $fasthash If true, use a low cost factor when generating the hash
* This is much faster to generate but makes the hash
* less secure. It is used when lots of hashes need to
* be generated quickly.
* @return string The hashed password.
*
* @throws moodle_exception If a problem occurs while generating the hash.
*/
function hash_internal_user_password($password, $fasthash = false) {
global $CFG;
require_once($CFG->libdir.'/password_compat/lib/password.php');
// Use the legacy hashing algorithm (md5) if PHP is not new enough
// to support bcrypt properly
if (password_compat_not_supported()) {
if (isset($CFG->passwordsaltmain)) {
return md5($password.$CFG->passwordsaltmain);
} else {
return md5($password);
}
}
// Set the cost factor to 4 for fast hashing, otherwise use default cost.
$options = ($fasthash) ? array('cost' => 4) : array();
$generatedhash = password_hash($password, PASSWORD_DEFAULT, $options);
if ($generatedhash === false) {
throw new moodle_exception('Failed to generate password hash.');
}
return $generatedhash;
}
/**
* Update password hash in user object (if necessary).
*
* The password is updated if:
* 1. The password has changed (the hash of $user->password is different
* to the hash of $password).
* 2. The existing hash is using an out-of-date algorithm (or the legacy
* md5 algorithm).
*
* Updating the password will modify the $user object and the database
* record to use the current hashing algorithm.
*
* @param stdClass $user User object (password property may be updated).
* @param string $password Plain text password.
* @return bool Always returns true.
*/
function update_internal_user_password($user, $password) {
global $CFG, $DB;
require_once($CFG->libdir.'/password_compat/lib/password.php');
// Use the legacy hashing algorithm (md5) if PHP doesn't support
// bcrypt properly.
$legacyhash = password_compat_not_supported();
// Figure out what the hashed password should be.
$authplugin = get_auth_plugin($user->auth);
if ($authplugin->prevent_local_passwords()) {
$hashedpassword = AUTH_PASSWORD_NOT_CACHED;
} else {
$hashedpassword = hash_internal_user_password($password);
}
if ($legacyhash) {
$passwordchanged = ($user->password !== $hashedpassword);
$algorithmchanged = false;
} else {
// If verification fails then it means the password has changed.
$passwordchanged = !password_verify($password, $user->password);
$algorithmchanged = password_needs_rehash($user->password, PASSWORD_DEFAULT);
}
if ($passwordchanged || $algorithmchanged) {
$DB->set_field('user', 'password', $hashedpassword, array('id'=>$user->id));
$user->password = $hashedpassword;
}
return true;
}
/**
* Get a complete user record, which includes all the info
* in the user record.
*
* Intended for setting as $USER session variable
*
* @param string $field The user field to be checked for a given value.
* @param string $value The value to match for $field.
* @param int $mnethostid
* @return mixed False, or A {@link $USER} object.
*/
function get_complete_user_data($field, $value, $mnethostid = null) {
global $CFG, $DB;
if (!$field || !$value) {
return false;
}
/// Build the WHERE clause for an SQL query
$params = array('fieldval'=>$value);
$constraints = "$field = :fieldval AND deleted <> 1";
// If we are loading user data based on anything other than id,
// we must also restrict our search based on mnet host.
if ($field != 'id') {
if (empty($mnethostid)) {
// if empty, we restrict to local users
$mnethostid = $CFG->mnet_localhost_id;
}
}
if (!empty($mnethostid)) {
$params['mnethostid'] = $mnethostid;
$constraints .= " AND mnethostid = :mnethostid";
}
/// Get all the basic user data
if (! $user = $DB->get_record_select('user', $constraints, $params)) {
return false;
}
/// Get various settings and preferences
// preload preference cache
check_user_preferences_loaded($user);
// load course enrolment related stuff
$user->lastcourseaccess = array(); // during last session
$user->currentcourseaccess = array(); // during current session
if ($lastaccesses = $DB->get_records('user_lastaccess', array('userid'=>$user->id))) {
foreach ($lastaccesses as $lastaccess) {
$user->lastcourseaccess[$lastaccess->courseid] = $lastaccess->timeaccess;
}
}
$sql = "SELECT g.id, g.courseid
FROM {groups} g, {groups_members} gm
WHERE gm.groupid=g.id AND gm.userid=?";
// this is a special hack to speedup calendar display
$user->groupmember = array();
if (!isguestuser($user)) {
if ($groups = $DB->get_records_sql($sql, array($user->id))) {
foreach ($groups as $group) {
if (!array_key_exists($group->courseid, $user->groupmember)) {
$user->groupmember[$group->courseid] = array();
}
$user->groupmember[$group->courseid][$group->id] = $group->id;
}
}
}
/// Add the custom profile fields to the user record
$user->profile = array();
if (!isguestuser($user)) {
require_once($CFG->dirroot.'/user/profile/lib.php');
profile_load_custom_fields($user);
}
/// Rewrite some variables if necessary
if (!empty($user->description)) {
$user->description = true; // No need to cart all of it around
}
if (isguestuser($user)) {
$user->lang = $CFG->lang; // Guest language always same as site
$user->firstname = get_string('guestuser'); // Name always in current language
$user->lastname = ' ';
}
return $user;
}
/**
* Validate a password against the configured password policy
*
* @global object
* @param string $password the password to be checked against the password policy
* @param string $errmsg the error message to display when the password doesn't comply with the policy.
* @return bool true if the password is valid according to the policy. false otherwise.
*/
function check_password_policy($password, &$errmsg) {
global $CFG;
if (empty($CFG->passwordpolicy)) {
return true;
}
$errmsg = '';
if (textlib::strlen($password) < $CFG->minpasswordlength) {
$errmsg .= '<div>'. get_string('errorminpasswordlength', 'auth', $CFG->minpasswordlength) .'</div>';
}
if (preg_match_all('/[[:digit:]]/u', $password, $matches) < $CFG->minpassworddigits) {
$errmsg .= '<div>'. get_string('errorminpassworddigits', 'auth', $CFG->minpassworddigits) .'</div>';
}
if (preg_match_all('/[[:lower:]]/u', $password, $matches) < $CFG->minpasswordlower) {
$errmsg .= '<div>'. get_string('errorminpasswordlower', 'auth', $CFG->minpasswordlower) .'</div>';
}
if (preg_match_all('/[[:upper:]]/u', $password, $matches) < $CFG->minpasswordupper) {
$errmsg .= '<div>'. get_string('errorminpasswordupper', 'auth', $CFG->minpasswordupper) .'</div>';
}
if (preg_match_all('/[^[:upper:][:lower:][:digit:]]/u', $password, $matches) < $CFG->minpasswordnonalphanum) {
$errmsg .= '<div>'. get_string('errorminpasswordnonalphanum', 'auth', $CFG->minpasswordnonalphanum) .'</div>';
}
if (!check_consecutive_identical_characters($password, $CFG->maxconsecutiveidentchars)) {
$errmsg .= '<div>'. get_string('errormaxconsecutiveidentchars', 'auth', $CFG->maxconsecutiveidentchars) .'</div>';
}
if ($errmsg == '') {
return true;
} else {
return false;
}
}
/**
* When logging in, this function is run to set certain preferences
* for the current SESSION
*
* @global object
* @global object
*/
function set_login_session_preferences() {
global $SESSION, $CFG;
$SESSION->justloggedin = true;
unset($SESSION->lang);
}
/**
* Delete a course, including all related data from the database,
* and any associated files.
*
* @global object
* @global object
* @param mixed $courseorid The id of the course or course object to delete.
* @param bool $showfeedback Whether to display notifications of each action the function performs.
* @return bool true if all the removals succeeded. false if there were any failures. If this
* method returns false, some of the removals will probably have succeeded, and others
* failed, but you have no way of knowing which.
*/
function delete_course($courseorid, $showfeedback = true) {
global $DB;
if (is_object($courseorid)) {
$courseid = $courseorid->id;
$course = $courseorid;
} else {
$courseid = $courseorid;
if (!$course = $DB->get_record('course', array('id'=>$courseid))) {
return false;
}
}
$context = context_course::instance($courseid);
// frontpage course can not be deleted!!
if ($courseid == SITEID) {
return false;
}
// make the course completely empty
remove_course_contents($courseid, $showfeedback);
// delete the course and related context instance
delete_context(CONTEXT_COURSE, $courseid);
// We will update the course's timemodified, as it will be passed to the course_deleted event,
// which should know about this updated property, as this event is meant to pass the full course record
$course->timemodified = time();
$DB->delete_records("course", array("id" => $courseid));
$DB->delete_records("course_format_options", array("courseid" => $courseid));
//trigger events
$course->context = $context; // you can not fetch context in the event because it was already deleted
events_trigger('course_deleted', $course);
return true;
}
/**
* Clear a course out completely, deleting all content
* but don't delete the course itself.
* This function does not verify any permissions.
*
* Please note this function also deletes all user enrolments,
* enrolment instances and role assignments by default.
*
* $options:
* - 'keep_roles_and_enrolments' - false by default
* - 'keep_groups_and_groupings' - false by default
*
* @param int $courseid The id of the course that is being deleted
* @param bool $showfeedback Whether to display notifications of each action the function performs.
* @param array $options extra options
* @return bool true if all the removals succeeded. false if there were any failures. If this
* method returns false, some of the removals will probably have succeeded, and others
* failed, but you have no way of knowing which.
*/
function remove_course_contents($courseid, $showfeedback = true, array $options = null) {
global $CFG, $DB, $OUTPUT;
require_once($CFG->libdir.'/completionlib.php');
require_once($CFG->libdir.'/questionlib.php');
require_once($CFG->libdir.'/gradelib.php');
require_once($CFG->dirroot.'/group/lib.php');
require_once($CFG->dirroot.'/tag/coursetagslib.php');
require_once($CFG->dirroot.'/comment/lib.php');
require_once($CFG->dirroot.'/rating/lib.php');
// NOTE: these concatenated strings are suboptimal, but it is just extra info...
$strdeleted = get_string('deleted').' - ';
// Some crazy wishlist of stuff we should skip during purging of course content
$options = (array)$options;
$course = $DB->get_record('course', array('id'=>$courseid), '*', MUST_EXIST);
$coursecontext = context_course::instance($courseid);
$fs = get_file_storage();
// Delete course completion information, this has to be done before grades and enrols
$cc = new completion_info($course);
$cc->clear_criteria();
if ($showfeedback) {
echo $OUTPUT->notification($strdeleted.get_string('completion', 'completion'), 'notifysuccess');
}
// Remove all data from gradebook - this needs to be done before course modules
// because while deleting this information, the system may need to reference
// the course modules that own the grades.
remove_course_grades($courseid, $showfeedback);
remove_grade_letters($coursecontext, $showfeedback);
// Delete course blocks in any all child contexts,
// they may depend on modules so delete them first
$childcontexts = $coursecontext->get_child_contexts(); // returns all subcontexts since 2.2
foreach ($childcontexts as $childcontext) {
blocks_delete_all_for_context($childcontext->id);
}
unset($childcontexts);
blocks_delete_all_for_context($coursecontext->id);
if ($showfeedback) {
echo $OUTPUT->notification($strdeleted.get_string('type_block_plural', 'plugin'), 'notifysuccess');
}
// Delete every instance of every module,
// this has to be done before deleting of course level stuff
$locations = get_plugin_list('mod');
foreach ($locations as $modname=>$moddir) {
if ($modname === 'NEWMODULE') {
continue;
}
if ($module = $DB->get_record('modules', array('name'=>$modname))) {
include_once("$moddir/lib.php"); // Shows php warning only if plugin defective
$moddelete = $modname .'_delete_instance'; // Delete everything connected to an instance
$moddeletecourse = $modname .'_delete_course'; // Delete other stray stuff (uncommon)
if ($instances = $DB->get_records($modname, array('course'=>$course->id))) {
foreach ($instances as $instance) {
if ($cm = get_coursemodule_from_instance($modname, $instance->id, $course->id)) {
/// Delete activity context questions and question categories
question_delete_activity($cm, $showfeedback);
}
if (function_exists($moddelete)) {
// This purges all module data in related tables, extra user prefs, settings, etc.
$moddelete($instance->id);
} else {
// NOTE: we should not allow installation of modules with missing delete support!
debugging("Defective module '$modname' detected when deleting course contents: missing function $moddelete()!");
$DB->delete_records($modname, array('id'=>$instance->id));
}
if ($cm) {
// Delete cm and its context - orphaned contexts are purged in cron in case of any race condition
context_helper::delete_instance(CONTEXT_MODULE, $cm->id);
$DB->delete_records('course_modules', array('id'=>$cm->id));
}
}
}
if (function_exists($moddeletecourse)) {
// Execute ptional course cleanup callback
$moddeletecourse($course, $showfeedback);
}
if ($instances and $showfeedback) {
echo $OUTPUT->notification($strdeleted.get_string('pluginname', $modname), 'notifysuccess');
}
} else {
// Ooops, this module is not properly installed, force-delete it in the next block
}
}
// We have tried to delete everything the nice way - now let's force-delete any remaining module data
// Remove all data from availability and completion tables that is associated
// with course-modules belonging to this course. Note this is done even if the
// features are not enabled now, in case they were enabled previously.
$DB->delete_records_select('course_modules_completion',
'coursemoduleid IN (SELECT id from {course_modules} WHERE course=?)',
array($courseid));
$DB->delete_records_select('course_modules_availability',
'coursemoduleid IN (SELECT id from {course_modules} WHERE course=?)',
array($courseid));
$DB->delete_records_select('course_modules_avail_fields',
'coursemoduleid IN (SELECT id from {course_modules} WHERE course=?)',
array($courseid));
// Remove course-module data.
$cms = $DB->get_records('course_modules', array('course'=>$course->id));
foreach ($cms as $cm) {
if ($module = $DB->get_record('modules', array('id'=>$cm->module))) {
try {
$DB->delete_records($module->name, array('id'=>$cm->instance));
} catch (Exception $e) {
// Ignore weird or missing table problems
}
}
context_helper::delete_instance(CONTEXT_MODULE, $cm->id);
$DB->delete_records('course_modules', array('id'=>$cm->id));
}
if ($showfeedback) {
echo $OUTPUT->notification($strdeleted.get_string('type_mod_plural', 'plugin'), 'notifysuccess');
}
// Cleanup the rest of plugins
$cleanuplugintypes = array('report', 'coursereport', 'format');
foreach ($cleanuplugintypes as $type) {
$plugins = get_plugin_list_with_function($type, 'delete_course', 'lib.php');
foreach ($plugins as $plugin=>$pluginfunction) {
$pluginfunction($course->id, $showfeedback);
}
if ($showfeedback) {
echo $OUTPUT->notification($strdeleted.get_string('type_'.$type.'_plural', 'plugin'), 'notifysuccess');
}
}
// Delete questions and question categories
question_delete_course($course, $showfeedback);
if ($showfeedback) {
echo $OUTPUT->notification($strdeleted.get_string('questions', 'question'), 'notifysuccess');
}
// Make sure there are no subcontexts left - all valid blocks and modules should be already gone
$childcontexts = $coursecontext->get_child_contexts(); // returns all subcontexts since 2.2
foreach ($childcontexts as $childcontext) {
$childcontext->delete();
}
unset($childcontexts);
// Remove all roles and enrolments by default
if (empty($options['keep_roles_and_enrolments'])) {
// this hack is used in restore when deleting contents of existing course
role_unassign_all(array('contextid'=>$coursecontext->id, 'component'=>''), true);
enrol_course_delete($course);
if ($showfeedback) {
echo $OUTPUT->notification($strdeleted.get_string('type_enrol_plural', 'plugin'), 'notifysuccess');
}
}
// Delete any groups, removing members and grouping/course links first.
if (empty($options['keep_groups_and_groupings'])) {
groups_delete_groupings($course->id, $showfeedback);
groups_delete_groups($course->id, $showfeedback);
}
// filters be gone!
filter_delete_all_for_context($coursecontext->id);
// die comments!
comment::delete_comments($coursecontext->id);
// ratings are history too
$delopt = new stdclass();
$delopt->contextid = $coursecontext->id;
$rm = new rating_manager();
$rm->delete_ratings($delopt);
// Delete course tags
coursetag_delete_course_tags($course->id, $showfeedback);
// Delete calendar events
$DB->delete_records('event', array('courseid'=>$course->id));
$fs->delete_area_files($coursecontext->id, 'calendar');
// Delete all related records in other core tables that may have a courseid
// This array stores the tables that need to be cleared, as
// table_name => column_name that contains the course id.
$tablestoclear = array(
'log' => 'course', // Course logs (NOTE: this might be changed in the future)
'backup_courses' => 'courseid', // Scheduled backup stuff
'user_lastaccess' => 'courseid', // User access info
);
foreach ($tablestoclear as $table => $col) {
$DB->delete_records($table, array($col=>$course->id));
}
// delete all course backup files
$fs->delete_area_files($coursecontext->id, 'backup');
// cleanup course record - remove links to deleted stuff
$oldcourse = new stdClass();
$oldcourse->id = $course->id;
$oldcourse->summary = '';
$oldcourse->modinfo = NULL;
$oldcourse->legacyfiles = 0;
$oldcourse->enablecompletion = 0;
if (!empty($options['keep_groups_and_groupings'])) {
$oldcourse->defaultgroupingid = 0;
}
$DB->update_record('course', $oldcourse);
// Delete course sections and availability options.
$DB->delete_records_select('course_sections_availability',
'coursesectionid IN (SELECT id from {course_sections} WHERE course=?)',
array($course->id));
$DB->delete_records_select('course_sections_avail_fields',
'coursesectionid IN (SELECT id from {course_sections} WHERE course=?)',
array($course->id));
$DB->delete_records('course_sections', array('course'=>$course->id));
// delete legacy, section and any other course files
$fs->delete_area_files($coursecontext->id, 'course'); // files from summary and section
// Delete all remaining stuff linked to context such as files, comments, ratings, etc.
if (empty($options['keep_roles_and_enrolments']) and empty($options['keep_groups_and_groupings'])) {
// Easy, do not delete the context itself...
$coursecontext->delete_content();
} else {
// Hack alert!!!!
// We can not drop all context stuff because it would bork enrolments and roles,
// there might be also files used by enrol plugins...
}
// Delete legacy files - just in case some files are still left there after conversion to new file api,
// also some non-standard unsupported plugins may try to store something there
fulldelete($CFG->dataroot.'/'.$course->id);
// Finally trigger the event
$course->context = $coursecontext; // you can not access context in cron event later after course is deleted
$course->options = $options; // not empty if we used any crazy hack
events_trigger('course_content_removed', $course);
return true;
}
/**
* Change dates in module - used from course reset.
*
* @global object
* @global object
* @param string $modname forum, assignment, etc
* @param array $fields array of date fields from mod table
* @param int $timeshift time difference
* @param int $courseid
* @return bool success
*/
function shift_course_mod_dates($modname, $fields, $timeshift, $courseid) {
global $CFG, $DB;
include_once($CFG->dirroot.'/mod/'.$modname.'/lib.php');
$return = true;
foreach ($fields as $field) {
$updatesql = "UPDATE {".$modname."}
SET $field = $field + ?
WHERE course=? AND $field<>0";
$return = $DB->execute($updatesql, array($timeshift, $courseid)) && $return;
}
$refreshfunction = $modname.'_refresh_events';
if (function_exists($refreshfunction)) {
$refreshfunction($courseid);
}
return $return;
}
/**
* This function will empty a course of user data.
* It will retain the activities and the structure of the course.
*
* @param object $data an object containing all the settings including courseid (without magic quotes)
* @return array status array of array component, item, error
*/
function reset_course_userdata($data) {
global $CFG, $USER, $DB;
require_once($CFG->libdir.'/gradelib.php');
require_once($CFG->libdir.'/completionlib.php');
require_once($CFG->dirroot.'/group/lib.php');
$data->courseid = $data->id;
$context = context_course::instance($data->courseid);
// calculate the time shift of dates
if (!empty($data->reset_start_date)) {
// time part of course startdate should be zero
$data->timeshift = $data->reset_start_date - usergetmidnight($data->reset_start_date_old);
} else {
$data->timeshift = 0;
}
// result array: component, item, error
$status = array();
// start the resetting
$componentstr = get_string('general');
// move the course start time
if (!empty($data->reset_start_date) and $data->timeshift) {
// change course start data
$DB->set_field('course', 'startdate', $data->reset_start_date, array('id'=>$data->courseid));
// update all course and group events - do not move activity events
$updatesql = "UPDATE {event}
SET timestart = timestart + ?
WHERE courseid=? AND instance=0";
$DB->execute($updatesql, array($data->timeshift, $data->courseid));
$status[] = array('component'=>$componentstr, 'item'=>get_string('datechanged'), 'error'=>false);
}
if (!empty($data->reset_logs)) {
$DB->delete_records('log', array('course'=>$data->courseid));
$status[] = array('component'=>$componentstr, 'item'=>get_string('deletelogs'), 'error'=>false);
}
if (!empty($data->reset_events)) {
$DB->delete_records('event', array('courseid'=>$data->courseid));
$status[] = array('component'=>$componentstr, 'item'=>get_string('deleteevents', 'calendar'), 'error'=>false);
}
if (!empty($data->reset_notes)) {
require_once($CFG->dirroot.'/notes/lib.php');
note_delete_all($data->courseid);
$status[] = array('component'=>$componentstr, 'item'=>get_string('deletenotes', 'notes'), 'error'=>false);
}
if (!empty($data->delete_blog_associations)) {
require_once($CFG->dirroot.'/blog/lib.php');
blog_remove_associations_for_course($data->courseid);
$status[] = array('component'=>$componentstr, 'item'=>get_string('deleteblogassociations', 'blog'), 'error'=>false);
}
if (!empty($data->reset_completion)) {
// Delete course and activity completion information.
$course = $DB->get_record('course', array('id'=>$data->courseid));
$cc = new completion_info($course);
$cc->delete_all_completion_data();
$status[] = array('component' => $componentstr,
'item' => get_string('deletecompletiondata', 'completion'), 'error' => false);
}
$componentstr = get_string('roles');
if (!empty($data->reset_roles_overrides)) {
$children = get_child_contexts($context);
foreach ($children as $child) {
$DB->delete_records('role_capabilities', array('contextid'=>$child->id));
}
$DB->delete_records('role_capabilities', array('contextid'=>$context->id));
//force refresh for logged in users
mark_context_dirty($context->path);
$status[] = array('component'=>$componentstr, 'item'=>get_string('deletecourseoverrides', 'role'), 'error'=>false);
}
if (!empty($data->reset_roles_local)) {
$children = get_child_contexts($context);
foreach ($children as $child) {
role_unassign_all(array('contextid'=>$child->id));
}
//force refresh for logged in users
mark_context_dirty($context->path);
$status[] = array('component'=>$componentstr, 'item'=>get_string('deletelocalroles', 'role'), 'error'=>false);
}
// First unenrol users - this cleans some of related user data too, such as forum subscriptions, tracking, etc.
$data->unenrolled = array();
if (!empty($data->unenrol_users)) {
$plugins = enrol_get_plugins(true);
$instances = enrol_get_instances($data->courseid, true);
foreach ($instances as $key=>$instance) {
if (!isset($plugins[$instance->enrol])) {
unset($instances[$key]);
continue;
}
}
foreach($data->unenrol_users as $withroleid) {
if ($withroleid) {
$sql = "SELECT ue.*
FROM {user_enrolments} ue
JOIN {enrol} e ON (e.id = ue.enrolid AND e.courseid = :courseid)
JOIN {context} c ON (c.contextlevel = :courselevel AND c.instanceid = e.courseid)
JOIN {role_assignments} ra ON (ra.contextid = c.id AND ra.roleid = :roleid AND ra.userid = ue.userid)";
$params = array('courseid'=>$data->courseid, 'roleid'=>$withroleid, 'courselevel'=>CONTEXT_COURSE);
} else {
// without any role assigned at course context
$sql = "SELECT ue.*
FROM {user_enrolments} ue
JOIN {enrol} e ON (e.id = ue.enrolid AND e.courseid = :courseid)
JOIN {context} c ON (c.contextlevel = :courselevel AND c.instanceid = e.courseid)
LEFT JOIN {role_assignments} ra ON (ra.contextid = c.id AND ra.userid = ue.userid)
WHERE ra.id IS NULL";
$params = array('courseid'=>$data->courseid, 'courselevel'=>CONTEXT_COURSE);
}
$rs = $DB->get_recordset_sql($sql, $params);
foreach ($rs as $ue) {
if (!isset($instances[$ue->enrolid])) {
continue;
}
$instance = $instances[$ue->enrolid];
$plugin = $plugins[$instance->enrol];
if (!$plugin->allow_unenrol($instance) and !$plugin->allow_unenrol_user($instance, $ue)) {
continue;
}
$plugin->unenrol_user($instance, $ue->userid);
$data->unenrolled[$ue->userid] = $ue->userid;
}
$rs->close();
}
}
if (!empty($data->unenrolled)) {
$status[] = array('component'=>$componentstr, 'item'=>get_string('unenrol', 'enrol').' ('.count($data->unenrolled).')', 'error'=>false);
}
$componentstr = get_string('groups');
// remove all group members
if (!empty($data->reset_groups_members)) {
groups_delete_group_members($data->courseid);
$status[] = array('component'=>$componentstr, 'item'=>get_string('removegroupsmembers', 'group'), 'error'=>false);
}
// remove all groups
if (!empty($data->reset_groups_remove)) {
groups_delete_groups($data->courseid, false);
$status[] = array('component'=>$componentstr, 'item'=>get_string('deleteallgroups', 'group'), 'error'=>false);
}
// remove all grouping members
if (!empty($data->reset_groupings_members)) {
groups_delete_groupings_groups($data->courseid, false);
$status[] = array('component'=>$componentstr, 'item'=>get_string('removegroupingsmembers', 'group'), 'error'=>false);
}
// remove all groupings
if (!empty($data->reset_groupings_remove)) {
groups_delete_groupings($data->courseid, false);
$status[] = array('component'=>$componentstr, 'item'=>get_string('deleteallgroupings', 'group'), 'error'=>false);
}
// Look in every instance of every module for data to delete
$unsupported_mods = array();
if ($allmods = $DB->get_records('modules') ) {
foreach ($allmods as $mod) {
$modname = $mod->name;
$modfile = $CFG->dirroot.'/mod/'. $modname.'/lib.php';
$moddeleteuserdata = $modname.'_reset_userdata'; // Function to delete user data
if (file_exists($modfile)) {
if (!$DB->count_records($modname, array('course'=>$data->courseid))) {
continue; // Skip mods with no instances
}
include_once($modfile);
if (function_exists($moddeleteuserdata)) {
$modstatus = $moddeleteuserdata($data);
if (is_array($modstatus)) {
$status = array_merge($status, $modstatus);
} else {
debugging('Module '.$modname.' returned incorrect staus - must be an array!');
}
} else {
$unsupported_mods[] = $mod;
}
} else {
debugging('Missing lib.php in '.$modname.' module!');
}
}
}
// mention unsupported mods
if (!empty($unsupported_mods)) {
foreach($unsupported_mods as $mod) {
$status[] = array('component'=>get_string('modulenameplural', $mod->name), 'item'=>'', 'error'=>get_string('resetnotimplemented'));
}
}
$componentstr = get_string('gradebook', 'grades');
// reset gradebook
if (!empty($data->reset_gradebook_items)) {
remove_course_grades($data->courseid, false);
grade_grab_course_grades($data->courseid);
grade_regrade_final_grades($data->courseid);
$status[] = array('component'=>$componentstr, 'item'=>get_string('removeallcourseitems', 'grades'), 'error'=>false);
} else if (!empty($data->reset_gradebook_grades)) {
grade_course_reset($data->courseid);
$status[] = array('component'=>$componentstr, 'item'=>get_string('removeallcoursegrades', 'grades'), 'error'=>false);
}
// reset comments
if (!empty($data->reset_comments)) {
require_once($CFG->dirroot.'/comment/lib.php');
comment::reset_course_page_comments($context);
}
return $status;
}
/**
* Generate an email processing address
*
* @param int $modid
* @param string $modargs
* @return string Returns email processing address
*/
function generate_email_processing_address($modid,$modargs) {
global $CFG;
$header = $CFG->mailprefix . substr(base64_encode(pack('C',$modid)),0,2).$modargs;
return $header . substr(md5($header.get_site_identifier()),0,16).'@'.$CFG->maildomain;
}
/**
* ?
*
* @todo Finish documenting this function
*
* @global object
* @param string $modargs
* @param string $body Currently unused
*/
function moodle_process_email($modargs,$body) {
global $DB;
// the first char should be an unencoded letter. We'll take this as an action
switch ($modargs{0}) {
case 'B': { // bounce
list(,$userid) = unpack('V',base64_decode(substr($modargs,1,8)));
if ($user = $DB->get_record("user", array('id'=>$userid), "id,email")) {
// check the half md5 of their email
$md5check = substr(md5($user->email),0,16);
if ($md5check == substr($modargs, -16)) {
set_bounce_count($user);
}
// else maybe they've already changed it?
}
}
break;
// maybe more later?
}
}
/// CORRESPONDENCE ////////////////////////////////////////////////
/**
* Get mailer instance, enable buffering, flush buffer or disable buffering.
*
* @param string $action 'get', 'buffer', 'close' or 'flush'
* @return moodle_phpmailer|null mailer instance if 'get' used or nothing
*/
function get_mailer($action='get') {
global $CFG;
static $mailer = null;
static $counter = 0;
if (!isset($CFG->smtpmaxbulk)) {
$CFG->smtpmaxbulk = 1;
}
if ($action == 'get') {
$prevkeepalive = false;
if (isset($mailer) and $mailer->Mailer == 'smtp') {
if ($counter < $CFG->smtpmaxbulk and !$mailer->IsError()) {
$counter++;
// reset the mailer
$mailer->Priority = 3;
$mailer->CharSet = 'UTF-8'; // our default
$mailer->ContentType = "text/plain";
$mailer->Encoding = "8bit";
$mailer->From = "root@localhost";
$mailer->FromName = "Root User";
$mailer->Sender = "";
$mailer->Subject = "";
$mailer->Body = "";
$mailer->AltBody = "";
$mailer->ConfirmReadingTo = "";
$mailer->ClearAllRecipients();
$mailer->ClearReplyTos();
$mailer->ClearAttachments();
$mailer->ClearCustomHeaders();
return $mailer;
}
$prevkeepalive = $mailer->SMTPKeepAlive;
get_mailer('flush');
}
include_once($CFG->libdir.'/phpmailer/moodle_phpmailer.php');
$mailer = new moodle_phpmailer();
$counter = 1;
$mailer->Version = 'Moodle '.$CFG->version; // mailer version
$mailer->PluginDir = $CFG->libdir.'/phpmailer/'; // plugin directory (eg smtp plugin)
$mailer->CharSet = 'UTF-8';
// some MTAs may do double conversion of LF if CRLF used, CRLF is required line ending in RFC 822bis
if (isset($CFG->mailnewline) and $CFG->mailnewline == 'CRLF') {
$mailer->LE = "\r\n";
} else {
$mailer->LE = "\n";
}
if ($CFG->smtphosts == 'qmail') {
$mailer->IsQmail(); // use Qmail system
} else if (empty($CFG->smtphosts)) {
$mailer->IsMail(); // use PHP mail() = sendmail
} else {
$mailer->IsSMTP(); // use SMTP directly
if (!empty($CFG->debugsmtp)) {
$mailer->SMTPDebug = true;
}
$mailer->Host = $CFG->smtphosts; // specify main and backup servers
$mailer->SMTPSecure = $CFG->smtpsecure; // specify secure connection protocol
$mailer->SMTPKeepAlive = $prevkeepalive; // use previous keepalive
if ($CFG->smtpuser) { // Use SMTP authentication
$mailer->SMTPAuth = true;
$mailer->Username = $CFG->smtpuser;
$mailer->Password = $CFG->smtppass;
}
}
return $mailer;
}
$nothing = null;
// keep smtp session open after sending
if ($action == 'buffer') {
if (!empty($CFG->smtpmaxbulk)) {
get_mailer('flush');
$m = get_mailer();
if ($m->Mailer == 'smtp') {
$m->SMTPKeepAlive = true;
}
}
return $nothing;
}
// close smtp session, but continue buffering
if ($action == 'flush') {
if (isset($mailer) and $mailer->Mailer == 'smtp') {
if (!empty($mailer->SMTPDebug)) {
echo '<pre>'."\n";
}
$mailer->SmtpClose();
if (!empty($mailer->SMTPDebug)) {
echo '</pre>';
}
}
return $nothing;
}
// close smtp session, do not buffer anymore
if ($action == 'close') {
if (isset($mailer) and $mailer->Mailer == 'smtp') {
get_mailer('flush');
$mailer->SMTPKeepAlive = false;
}
$mailer = null; // better force new instance
return $nothing;
}
}
/**
* Send an email to a specified user
*
* @global object
* @global string
* @global string IdentityProvider(IDP) URL user hits to jump to mnet peer.
* @uses SITEID
* @param stdClass $user A {@link $USER} object
* @param stdClass $from A {@link $USER} object
* @param string $subject plain text subject line of the email
* @param string $messagetext plain text version of the message
* @param string $messagehtml complete html version of the message (optional)
* @param string $attachment a file on the filesystem, relative to $CFG->dataroot
* @param string $attachname the name of the file (extension indicates MIME)
* @param bool $usetrueaddress determines whether $from email address should
* be sent out. Will be overruled by user profile setting for maildisplay
* @param string $replyto Email address to reply to
* @param string $replytoname Name of reply to recipient
* @param int $wordwrapwidth custom word wrap width, default 79
* @return bool Returns true if mail was sent OK and false if there was an error.
*/
function email_to_user($user, $from, $subject, $messagetext, $messagehtml='', $attachment='', $attachname='', $usetrueaddress=true, $replyto='', $replytoname='', $wordwrapwidth=79) {
global $CFG;
if (empty($user) || empty($user->email)) {
$nulluser = 'User is null or has no email';
error_log($nulluser);
if (CLI_SCRIPT) {
mtrace('Error: lib/moodlelib.php email_to_user(): '.$nulluser);
}
return false;
}
if (!empty($user->deleted)) {
// do not mail deleted users
$userdeleted = 'User is deleted';
error_log($userdeleted);
if (CLI_SCRIPT) {
mtrace('Error: lib/moodlelib.php email_to_user(): '.$userdeleted);
}
return false;
}
if (!empty($CFG->noemailever)) {
// hidden setting for development sites, set in config.php if needed
$noemail = 'Not sending email due to noemailever config setting';
error_log($noemail);
if (CLI_SCRIPT) {
mtrace('Error: lib/moodlelib.php email_to_user(): '.$noemail);
}
return true;
}
if (!empty($CFG->divertallemailsto)) {
$subject = "[DIVERTED {$user->email}] $subject";
$user = clone($user);
$user->email = $CFG->divertallemailsto;
}
// skip mail to suspended users
if ((isset($user->auth) && $user->auth=='nologin') or (isset($user->suspended) && $user->suspended)) {
return true;
}
if (!validate_email($user->email)) {
// we can not send emails to invalid addresses - it might create security issue or confuse the mailer
$invalidemail = "User $user->id (".fullname($user).") email ($user->email) is invalid! Not sending.";
error_log($invalidemail);
if (CLI_SCRIPT) {
mtrace('Error: lib/moodlelib.php email_to_user(): '.$invalidemail);
}
return false;
}
if (over_bounce_threshold($user)) {
$bouncemsg = "User $user->id (".fullname($user).") is over bounce threshold! Not sending.";
error_log($bouncemsg);
if (CLI_SCRIPT) {
mtrace('Error: lib/moodlelib.php email_to_user(): '.$bouncemsg);
}
return false;
}
// If the user is a remote mnet user, parse the email text for URL to the
// wwwroot and modify the url to direct the user's browser to login at their
// home site (identity provider - idp) before hitting the link itself
if (is_mnet_remote_user($user)) {
require_once($CFG->dirroot.'/mnet/lib.php');
$jumpurl = mnet_get_idp_jump_url($user);
$callback = partial('mnet_sso_apply_indirection', $jumpurl);
$messagetext = preg_replace_callback("%($CFG->wwwroot[^[:space:]]*)%",
$callback,
$messagetext);
$messagehtml = preg_replace_callback("%href=[\"'`]($CFG->wwwroot[\w_:\?=#&@/;.~-]*)[\"'`]%",
$callback,
$messagehtml);
}
$mail = get_mailer();
if (!empty($mail->SMTPDebug)) {
echo '<pre>' . "\n";
}
$temprecipients = array();
$tempreplyto = array();
$supportuser = generate_email_supportuser();
// make up an email address for handling bounces
if (!empty($CFG->handlebounces)) {
$modargs = 'B'.base64_encode(pack('V',$user->id)).substr(md5($user->email),0,16);
$mail->Sender = generate_email_processing_address(0,$modargs);
} else {
$mail->Sender = $supportuser->email;
}
if (is_string($from)) { // So we can pass whatever we want if there is need
$mail->From = $CFG->noreplyaddress;
$mail->FromName = $from;
} else if ($usetrueaddress and $from->maildisplay) {
$mail->From = $from->email;
$mail->FromName = fullname($from);
} else {
$mail->From = $CFG->noreplyaddress;
$mail->FromName = fullname($from);
if (empty($replyto)) {
$tempreplyto[] = array($CFG->noreplyaddress, get_string('noreplyname'));
}
}
if (!empty($replyto)) {
$tempreplyto[] = array($replyto, $replytoname);
}
$mail->Subject = substr($subject, 0, 900);
$temprecipients[] = array($user->email, fullname($user));
$mail->WordWrap = $wordwrapwidth; // set word wrap
if (!empty($from->customheaders)) { // Add custom headers
if (is_array($from->customheaders)) {
foreach ($from->customheaders as $customheader) {
$mail->AddCustomHeader($customheader);
}
} else {
$mail->AddCustomHeader($from->customheaders);
}
}
if (!empty($from->priority)) {
$mail->Priority = $from->priority;
}
if ($messagehtml && !empty($user->mailformat) && $user->mailformat == 1) { // Don't ever send HTML to users who don't want it
$mail->IsHTML(true);
$mail->Encoding = 'quoted-printable'; // Encoding to use
$mail->Body = $messagehtml;
$mail->AltBody = "\n$messagetext\n";
} else {
$mail->IsHTML(false);
$mail->Body = "\n$messagetext\n";
}
if ($attachment && $attachname) {
if (preg_match( "~\\.\\.~" ,$attachment )) { // Security check for ".." in dir path
$temprecipients[] = array($supportuser->email, fullname($supportuser, true));
$mail->AddStringAttachment('Error in attachment. User attempted to attach a filename with a unsafe name.', 'error.txt', '8bit', 'text/plain');
} else {
require_once($CFG->libdir.'/filelib.php');
$mimetype = mimeinfo('type', $attachname);
$mail->AddAttachment($CFG->dataroot .'/'. $attachment, $attachname, 'base64', $mimetype);
}
}
// Check if the email should be sent in an other charset then the default UTF-8
if ((!empty($CFG->sitemailcharset) || !empty($CFG->allowusermailcharset))) {
// use the defined site mail charset or eventually the one preferred by the recipient
$charset = $CFG->sitemailcharset;
if (!empty($CFG->allowusermailcharset)) {
if ($useremailcharset = get_user_preferences('mailcharset', '0', $user->id)) {
$charset = $useremailcharset;
}
}
// convert all the necessary strings if the charset is supported
$charsets = get_list_of_charsets();
unset($charsets['UTF-8']);
if (in_array($charset, $charsets)) {
$mail->CharSet = $charset;
$mail->FromName = textlib::convert($mail->FromName, 'utf-8', strtolower($charset));
$mail->Subject = textlib::convert($mail->Subject, 'utf-8', strtolower($charset));
$mail->Body = textlib::convert($mail->Body, 'utf-8', strtolower($charset));
$mail->AltBody = textlib::convert($mail->AltBody, 'utf-8', strtolower($charset));
foreach ($temprecipients as $key => $values) {
$temprecipients[$key][1] = textlib::convert($values[1], 'utf-8', strtolower($charset));
}
foreach ($tempreplyto as $key => $values) {
$tempreplyto[$key][1] = textlib::convert($values[1], 'utf-8', strtolower($charset));
}
}
}
foreach ($temprecipients as $values) {
$mail->AddAddress($values[0], $values[1]);
}
foreach ($tempreplyto as $values) {
$mail->AddReplyTo($values[0], $values[1]);
}
if ($mail->Send()) {
set_send_count($user);
if (!empty($mail->SMTPDebug)) {
echo '</pre>';
}
return true;
} else {
add_to_log(SITEID, 'library', 'mailer', qualified_me(), 'ERROR: '. $mail->ErrorInfo);
if (CLI_SCRIPT) {
mtrace('Error: lib/moodlelib.php email_to_user(): '.$mail->ErrorInfo);
}
if (!empty($mail->SMTPDebug)) {
echo '</pre>';
}
return false;
}
}
/**
* Generate a signoff for emails based on support settings
*
* @global object
* @return string
*/
function generate_email_signoff() {
global $CFG;
$signoff = "\n";
if (!empty($CFG->supportname)) {
$signoff .= $CFG->supportname."\n";
}
if (!empty($CFG->supportemail)) {
$signoff .= $CFG->supportemail."\n";
}
if (!empty($CFG->supportpage)) {
$signoff .= $CFG->supportpage."\n";
}
return $signoff;
}
/**
* Generate a fake user for emails based on support settings
* @global object
* @return object user info
*/
function generate_email_supportuser() {
global $CFG;
static $supportuser;
if (!empty($supportuser)) {
return $supportuser;
}
$supportuser = new stdClass();
$supportuser->email = $CFG->supportemail ? $CFG->supportemail : $CFG->noreplyaddress;
$supportuser->firstname = $CFG->supportname ? $CFG->supportname : get_string('noreplyname');
$supportuser->lastname = '';
$supportuser->maildisplay = true;
return $supportuser;
}
/**
* Sets specified user's password and send the new password to the user via email.
*
* @global object
* @global object
* @param user $user A {@link $USER} object
* @param boolean $fasthash If true, use a low cost factor when generating the hash for speed.
* @return boolean|string Returns "true" if mail was sent OK and "false" if there was an error
*/
function setnew_password_and_mail($user, $fasthash = false) {
global $CFG, $DB;
// we try to send the mail in language the user understands,
// unfortunately the filter_string() does not support alternative langs yet
// so multilang will not work properly for site->fullname
$lang = empty($user->lang) ? $CFG->lang : $user->lang;
$site = get_site();
$supportuser = generate_email_supportuser();
$newpassword = generate_password();
$hashedpassword = hash_internal_user_password($newpassword, $fasthash);
$DB->set_field('user', 'password', $hashedpassword, array('id'=>$user->id));
$a = new stdClass();
$a->firstname = fullname($user, true);
$a->sitename = format_string($site->fullname);
$a->username = $user->username;
$a->newpassword = $newpassword;
$a->link = $CFG->wwwroot .'/login/';
$a->signoff = generate_email_signoff();
$message = (string)new lang_string('newusernewpasswordtext', '', $a, $lang);
$subject = format_string($site->fullname) .': '. (string)new lang_string('newusernewpasswordsubj', '', $a, $lang);
//directly email rather than using the messaging system to ensure its not routed to a popup or jabber
return email_to_user($user, $supportuser, $subject, $message);
}
/**
* Resets specified user's password and send the new password to the user via email.
*
* @param stdClass $user A {@link $USER} object
* @return bool Returns true if mail was sent OK and false if there was an error.
*/
function reset_password_and_mail($user) {
global $CFG;
$site = get_site();
$supportuser = generate_email_supportuser();
$userauth = get_auth_plugin($user->auth);
if (!$userauth->can_reset_password() or !is_enabled_auth($user->auth)) {
trigger_error("Attempt to reset user password for user $user->username with Auth $user->auth.");
return false;
}
$newpassword = generate_password();
if (!$userauth->user_update_password($user, $newpassword)) {
print_error("cannotsetpassword");
}
$a = new stdClass();
$a->firstname = $user->firstname;
$a->lastname = $user->lastname;
$a->sitename = format_string($site->fullname);
$a->username = $user->username;
$a->newpassword = $newpassword;
$a->link = $CFG->httpswwwroot .'/login/change_password.php';
$a->signoff = generate_email_signoff();
$message = get_string('newpasswordtext', '', $a);
$subject = format_string($site->fullname) .': '. get_string('changedpassword');
unset_user_preference('create_password', $user); // prevent cron from generating the password
//directly email rather than using the messaging system to ensure its not routed to a popup or jabber
return email_to_user($user, $supportuser, $subject, $message);
}
/**
* Send email to specified user with confirmation text and activation link.
*
* @global object
* @param user $user A {@link $USER} object
* @return bool Returns true if mail was sent OK and false if there was an error.
*/
function send_confirmation_email($user) {
global $CFG;
$site = get_site();
$supportuser = generate_email_supportuser();
$data = new stdClass();
$data->firstname = fullname($user);
$data->sitename = format_string($site->fullname);
$data->admin = generate_email_signoff();
$subject = get_string('emailconfirmationsubject', '', format_string($site->fullname));
$username = urlencode($user->username);
$username = str_replace('.', '%2E', $username); // prevent problems with trailing dots
$data->link = $CFG->wwwroot .'/login/confirm.php?data='. $user->secret .'/'. $username;
$message = get_string('emailconfirmation', '', $data);
$messagehtml = text_to_html(get_string('emailconfirmation', '', $data), false, false, true);
$user->mailformat = 1; // Always send HTML version as well
//directly email rather than using the messaging system to ensure its not routed to a popup or jabber
return email_to_user($user, $supportuser, $subject, $message, $messagehtml);
}
/**
* send_password_change_confirmation_email.
*
* @global object
* @param user $user A {@link $USER} object
* @return bool Returns true if mail was sent OK and false if there was an error.
*/
function send_password_change_confirmation_email($user) {
global $CFG;
$site = get_site();
$supportuser = generate_email_supportuser();
$data = new stdClass();
$data->firstname = $user->firstname;
$data->lastname = $user->lastname;
$data->sitename = format_string($site->fullname);
$data->link = $CFG->httpswwwroot .'/login/forgot_password.php?p='. $user->secret .'&s='. urlencode($user->username);
$data->admin = generate_email_signoff();
$message = get_string('emailpasswordconfirmation', '', $data);
$subject = get_string('emailpasswordconfirmationsubject', '', format_string($site->fullname));
//directly email rather than using the messaging system to ensure its not routed to a popup or jabber
return email_to_user($user, $supportuser, $subject, $message);
}
/**
* send_password_change_info.
*
* @global object
* @param user $user A {@link $USER} object
* @return bool Returns true if mail was sent OK and false if there was an error.
*/
function send_password_change_info($user) {
global $CFG;
$site = get_site();
$supportuser = generate_email_supportuser();
$systemcontext = context_system::instance();
$data = new stdClass();
$data->firstname = $user->firstname;
$data->lastname = $user->lastname;
$data->sitename = format_string($site->fullname);
$data->admin = generate_email_signoff();
$userauth = get_auth_plugin($user->auth);
if (!is_enabled_auth($user->auth) or $user->auth == 'nologin') {
$message = get_string('emailpasswordchangeinfodisabled', '', $data);
$subject = get_string('emailpasswordchangeinfosubject', '', format_string($site->fullname));
//directly email rather than using the messaging system to ensure its not routed to a popup or jabber
return email_to_user($user, $supportuser, $subject, $message);
}
if ($userauth->can_change_password() and $userauth->change_password_url()) {
// we have some external url for password changing
$data->link .= $userauth->change_password_url();
} else {
//no way to change password, sorry
$data->link = '';
}
if (!empty($data->link) and has_capability('moodle/user:changeownpassword', $systemcontext, $user->id)) {
$message = get_string('emailpasswordchangeinfo', '', $data);
$subject = get_string('emailpasswordchangeinfosubject', '', format_string($site->fullname));
} else {
$message = get_string('emailpasswordchangeinfofail', '', $data);
$subject = get_string('emailpasswordchangeinfosubject', '', format_string($site->fullname));
}
//directly email rather than using the messaging system to ensure its not routed to a popup or jabber
return email_to_user($user, $supportuser, $subject, $message);
}
/**
* Check that an email is allowed. It returns an error message if there
* was a problem.
*
* @global object
* @param string $email Content of email
* @return string|false
*/
function email_is_not_allowed($email) {
global $CFG;
if (!empty($CFG->allowemailaddresses)) {
$allowed = explode(' ', $CFG->allowemailaddresses);
foreach ($allowed as $allowedpattern) {
$allowedpattern = trim($allowedpattern);
if (!$allowedpattern) {
continue;
}
if (strpos($allowedpattern, '.') === 0) {
if (strpos(strrev($email), strrev($allowedpattern)) === 0) {
// subdomains are in a form ".example.com" - matches "xxx@anything.example.com"
return false;
}
} else if (strpos(strrev($email), strrev('@'.$allowedpattern)) === 0) { // Match! (bug 5250)
return false;
}
}
return get_string('emailonlyallowed', '', $CFG->allowemailaddresses);
} else if (!empty($CFG->denyemailaddresses)) {
$denied = explode(' ', $CFG->denyemailaddresses);
foreach ($denied as $deniedpattern) {
$deniedpattern = trim($deniedpattern);
if (!$deniedpattern) {
continue;
}
if (strpos($deniedpattern, '.') === 0) {
if (strpos(strrev($email), strrev($deniedpattern)) === 0) {
// subdomains are in a form ".example.com" - matches "xxx@anything.example.com"
return get_string('emailnotallowed', '', $CFG->denyemailaddresses);
}
} else if (strpos(strrev($email), strrev('@'.$deniedpattern)) === 0) { // Match! (bug 5250)
return get_string('emailnotallowed', '', $CFG->denyemailaddresses);
}
}
}
return false;
}
/// FILE HANDLING /////////////////////////////////////////////
/**
* Returns local file storage instance
*
* @return file_storage
*/
function get_file_storage() {
global $CFG;
static $fs = null;
if ($fs) {
return $fs;
}
require_once("$CFG->libdir/filelib.php");
if (isset($CFG->filedir)) {
$filedir = $CFG->filedir;
} else {
$filedir = $CFG->dataroot.'/filedir';
}
if (isset($CFG->trashdir)) {
$trashdirdir = $CFG->trashdir;
} else {
$trashdirdir = $CFG->dataroot.'/trashdir';
}
$fs = new file_storage($filedir, $trashdirdir, "$CFG->tempdir/filestorage", $CFG->directorypermissions, $CFG->filepermissions);
return $fs;
}
/**
* Returns local file storage instance
*
* @return file_browser
*/
function get_file_browser() {
global $CFG;
static $fb = null;
if ($fb) {
return $fb;
}
require_once("$CFG->libdir/filelib.php");
$fb = new file_browser();
return $fb;
}
/**
* Returns file packer
*
* @param string $mimetype default application/zip
* @return file_packer
*/
function get_file_packer($mimetype='application/zip') {
global $CFG;
static $fp = array();
if (isset($fp[$mimetype])) {
return $fp[$mimetype];
}
switch ($mimetype) {
case 'application/zip':
case 'application/vnd.moodle.backup':
$classname = 'zip_packer';
break;
case 'application/x-tar':
// $classname = 'tar_packer';
// break;
default:
return false;
}
require_once("$CFG->libdir/filestorage/$classname.php");
$fp[$mimetype] = new $classname();
return $fp[$mimetype];
}
/**
* Returns current name of file on disk if it exists.
*
* @param string $newfile File to be verified
* @return string Current name of file on disk if true
*/
function valid_uploaded_file($newfile) {
if (empty($newfile)) {
return '';
}
if (is_uploaded_file($newfile['tmp_name']) and $newfile['size'] > 0) {
return $newfile['tmp_name'];
} else {
return '';
}
}
/**
* Returns the maximum size for uploading files.
*
* There are seven possible upload limits:
* 1. in Apache using LimitRequestBody (no way of checking or changing this)
* 2. in php.ini for 'upload_max_filesize' (can not be changed inside PHP)
* 3. in .htaccess for 'upload_max_filesize' (can not be changed inside PHP)
* 4. in php.ini for 'post_max_size' (can not be changed inside PHP)
* 5. by the Moodle admin in $CFG->maxbytes
* 6. by the teacher in the current course $course->maxbytes
* 7. by the teacher for the current module, eg $assignment->maxbytes
*
* These last two are passed to this function as arguments (in bytes).
* Anything defined as 0 is ignored.
* The smallest of all the non-zero numbers is returned.
*
* @todo Finish documenting this function
*
* @param int $sizebytes Set maximum size
* @param int $coursebytes Current course $course->maxbytes (in bytes)
* @param int $modulebytes Current module ->maxbytes (in bytes)
* @return int The maximum size for uploading files.
*/
function get_max_upload_file_size($sitebytes=0, $coursebytes=0, $modulebytes=0) {
if (! $filesize = ini_get('upload_max_filesize')) {
$filesize = '5M';
}
$minimumsize = get_real_size($filesize);
if ($postsize = ini_get('post_max_size')) {
$postsize = get_real_size($postsize);
if ($postsize < $minimumsize) {
$minimumsize = $postsize;
}
}
if (($sitebytes > 0) and ($sitebytes < $minimumsize)) {
$minimumsize = $sitebytes;
}
if (($coursebytes > 0) and ($coursebytes < $minimumsize)) {
$minimumsize = $coursebytes;
}
if (($modulebytes > 0) and ($modulebytes < $minimumsize)) {
$minimumsize = $modulebytes;
}
return $minimumsize;
}
/**
* Returns the maximum size for uploading files for the current user
*
* This function takes in account @see:get_max_upload_file_size() the user's capabilities
*
* @param context $context The context in which to check user capabilities
* @param int $sizebytes Set maximum size
* @param int $coursebytes Current course $course->maxbytes (in bytes)
* @param int $modulebytes Current module ->maxbytes (in bytes)
* @param stdClass The user
* @return int The maximum size for uploading files.
*/
function get_user_max_upload_file_size($context, $sitebytes=0, $coursebytes=0, $modulebytes=0, $user=null) {
global $USER;
if (empty($user)) {
$user = $USER;
}
if (has_capability('moodle/course:ignorefilesizelimits', $context, $user)) {
return USER_CAN_IGNORE_FILE_SIZE_LIMITS;
}
return get_max_upload_file_size($sitebytes, $coursebytes, $modulebytes);
}
/**
* Returns an array of possible sizes in local language
*
* Related to {@link get_max_upload_file_size()} - this function returns an
* array of possible sizes in an array, translated to the
* local language.
*
* The list of options will go up to the minimum of $sitebytes, $coursebytes or $modulebytes.
*
* If $coursebytes or $sitebytes is not 0, an option will be included for "Course/Site upload limit (X)"
* with the value set to 0. This option will be the first in the list.
*
* @global object
* @uses SORT_NUMERIC
* @param int $sizebytes Set maximum size
* @param int $coursebytes Current course $course->maxbytes (in bytes)
* @param int $modulebytes Current module ->maxbytes (in bytes)
* @param int|array $custombytes custom upload size/s which will be added to list,
* Only value/s smaller then maxsize will be added to list.
* @return array
*/
function get_max_upload_sizes($sitebytes = 0, $coursebytes = 0, $modulebytes = 0, $custombytes = null) {
global $CFG;
if (!$maxsize = get_max_upload_file_size($sitebytes, $coursebytes, $modulebytes)) {
return array();
}
$filesize = array();
$filesize[(string)intval($maxsize)] = display_size($maxsize);
$sizelist = array(10240, 51200, 102400, 512000, 1048576, 2097152,
5242880, 10485760, 20971520, 52428800, 104857600);
// If custombytes is given and is valid then add it to the list.
if (is_number($custombytes) and $custombytes > 0) {
$custombytes = (int)$custombytes;
if (!in_array($custombytes, $sizelist)) {
$sizelist[] = $custombytes;
}
} else if (is_array($custombytes)) {
$sizelist = array_unique(array_merge($sizelist, $custombytes));
}
// Allow maxbytes to be selected if it falls outside the above boundaries
if (isset($CFG->maxbytes) && !in_array(get_real_size($CFG->maxbytes), $sizelist)) {
// note: get_real_size() is used in order to prevent problems with invalid values
$sizelist[] = get_real_size($CFG->maxbytes);
}
foreach ($sizelist as $sizebytes) {
if ($sizebytes < $maxsize && $sizebytes > 0) {
$filesize[(string)intval($sizebytes)] = display_size($sizebytes);
}
}
krsort($filesize, SORT_NUMERIC);
$limitlevel = '';
$displaysize = '';
if ($modulebytes &&
(($modulebytes < $coursebytes || $coursebytes == 0) &&
($modulebytes < $sitebytes || $sitebytes == 0))) {
$limitlevel = get_string('activity', 'core');
$displaysize = display_size($modulebytes);
} else if ($coursebytes && ($coursebytes < $sitebytes || $sitebytes == 0)) {
$limitlevel = get_string('course', 'core');
$displaysize = display_size($coursebytes);
} else if ($sitebytes) {
$limitlevel = get_string('site', 'core');
$displaysize = display_size($sitebytes);
}
if ($limitlevel) {
$params = (object) array('contextname'=>$limitlevel, 'displaysize'=>$displaysize);
$filesize = array('0'=>get_string('uploadlimitwithsize', 'core', $params)) + $filesize;
}
return $filesize;
}
/**
* Returns an array with all the filenames in all subdirectories, relative to the given rootdir.
*
* If excludefiles is defined, then that file/directory is ignored
* If getdirs is true, then (sub)directories are included in the output
* If getfiles is true, then files are included in the output
* (at least one of these must be true!)
*
* @todo Finish documenting this function. Add examples of $excludefile usage.
*
* @param string $rootdir A given root directory to start from
* @param string|array $excludefile If defined then the specified file/directory is ignored
* @param bool $descend If true then subdirectories are recursed as well
* @param bool $getdirs If true then (sub)directories are included in the output
* @param bool $getfiles If true then files are included in the output
* @return array An array with all the filenames in
* all subdirectories, relative to the given rootdir
*/
function get_directory_list($rootdir, $excludefiles='', $descend=true, $getdirs=false, $getfiles=true) {
$dirs = array();
if (!$getdirs and !$getfiles) { // Nothing to show
return $dirs;
}
if (!is_dir($rootdir)) { // Must be a directory
return $dirs;
}
if (!$dir = opendir($rootdir)) { // Can't open it for some reason
return $dirs;
}
if (!is_array($excludefiles)) {
$excludefiles = array($excludefiles);
}
while (false !== ($file = readdir($dir))) {
$firstchar = substr($file, 0, 1);
if ($firstchar == '.' or $file == 'CVS' or in_array($file, $excludefiles)) {
continue;
}
$fullfile = $rootdir .'/'. $file;
if (filetype($fullfile) == 'dir') {
if ($getdirs) {
$dirs[] = $file;
}
if ($descend) {
$subdirs = get_directory_list($fullfile, $excludefiles, $descend, $getdirs, $getfiles);
foreach ($subdirs as $subdir) {
$dirs[] = $file .'/'. $subdir;
}
}
} else if ($getfiles) {
$dirs[] = $file;
}
}
closedir($dir);
asort($dirs);
return $dirs;
}
/**
* Adds up all the files in a directory and works out the size.
*
* @todo Finish documenting this function
*
* @param string $rootdir The directory to start from
* @param string $excludefile A file to exclude when summing directory size
* @return int The summed size of all files and subfiles within the root directory
*/
function get_directory_size($rootdir, $excludefile='') {
global $CFG;
// do it this way if we can, it's much faster
if (!empty($CFG->pathtodu) && is_executable(trim($CFG->pathtodu))) {
$command = trim($CFG->pathtodu).' -sk '.escapeshellarg($rootdir);
$output = null;
$return = null;
exec($command,$output,$return);
if (is_array($output)) {
return get_real_size(intval($output[0]).'k'); // we told it to return k.
}
}
if (!is_dir($rootdir)) { // Must be a directory
return 0;
}
if (!$dir = @opendir($rootdir)) { // Can't open it for some reason
return 0;
}
$size = 0;
while (false !== ($file = readdir($dir))) {
$firstchar = substr($file, 0, 1);
if ($firstchar == '.' or $file == 'CVS' or $file == $excludefile) {
continue;
}
$fullfile = $rootdir .'/'. $file;
if (filetype($fullfile) == 'dir') {
$size += get_directory_size($fullfile, $excludefile);
} else {
$size += filesize($fullfile);
}
}
closedir($dir);
return $size;
}
/**
* Converts bytes into display form
*
* @todo Finish documenting this function. Verify return type.
*
* @staticvar string $gb Localized string for size in gigabytes
* @staticvar string $mb Localized string for size in megabytes
* @staticvar string $kb Localized string for size in kilobytes
* @staticvar string $b Localized string for size in bytes
* @param int $size The size to convert to human readable form
* @return string
*/
function display_size($size) {
static $gb, $mb, $kb, $b;
if ($size === USER_CAN_IGNORE_FILE_SIZE_LIMITS) {
return get_string('unlimited');
}
if (empty($gb)) {
$gb = get_string('sizegb');
$mb = get_string('sizemb');
$kb = get_string('sizekb');
$b = get_string('sizeb');
}
if ($size >= 1073741824) {
$size = round($size / 1073741824 * 10) / 10 . $gb;
} else if ($size >= 1048576) {
$size = round($size / 1048576 * 10) / 10 . $mb;
} else if ($size >= 1024) {
$size = round($size / 1024 * 10) / 10 . $kb;
} else {
$size = intval($size) .' '. $b; // file sizes over 2GB can not work in 32bit PHP anyway
}
return $size;
}
/**
* Cleans a given filename by removing suspicious or troublesome characters
* @see clean_param()
*
* @uses PARAM_FILE
* @param string $string file name
* @return string cleaned file name
*/
function clean_filename($string) {
return clean_param($string, PARAM_FILE);
}
/// STRING TRANSLATION ////////////////////////////////////////
/**
* Returns the code for the current language
*
* @category string
* @return string
*/
function current_language() {
global $CFG, $USER, $SESSION, $COURSE;
if (!empty($COURSE->id) and $COURSE->id != SITEID and !empty($COURSE->lang)) { // Course language can override all other settings for this page
$return = $COURSE->lang;
} else if (!empty($SESSION->lang)) { // Session language can override other settings
$return = $SESSION->lang;
} else if (!empty($USER->lang)) {
$return = $USER->lang;
} else if (isset($CFG->lang)) {
$return = $CFG->lang;
} else {
$return = 'en';
}
$return = str_replace('_utf8', '', $return); // Just in case this slipped in from somewhere by accident
return $return;
}
/**
* Returns parent language of current active language if defined
*
* @category string
* @uses COURSE
* @uses SESSION
* @param string $lang null means current language
* @return string
*/
function get_parent_language($lang=null) {
global $COURSE, $SESSION;
//let's hack around the current language
if (!empty($lang)) {
$old_course_lang = empty($COURSE->lang) ? '' : $COURSE->lang;
$old_session_lang = empty($SESSION->lang) ? '' : $SESSION->lang;
$COURSE->lang = '';
$SESSION->lang = $lang;
}
$parentlang = get_string('parentlanguage', 'langconfig');
if ($parentlang === 'en') {
$parentlang = '';
}
//let's hack around the current language
if (!empty($lang)) {
$COURSE->lang = $old_course_lang;
$SESSION->lang = $old_session_lang;
}
return $parentlang;
}
/**
* Returns current string_manager instance.
*
* The param $forcereload is needed for CLI installer only where the string_manager instance
* must be replaced during the install.php script life time.
*
* @category string
* @param bool $forcereload shall the singleton be released and new instance created instead?
* @return string_manager
*/
function get_string_manager($forcereload=false) {
global $CFG;
static $singleton = null;
if ($forcereload) {
$singleton = null;
}
if ($singleton === null) {
if (empty($CFG->early_install_lang)) {
if (empty($CFG->langlist)) {
$translist = array();
} else {
$translist = explode(',', $CFG->langlist);
}
if (empty($CFG->langmenucachefile)) {
$langmenucache = $CFG->cachedir . '/languages';
} else {
$langmenucache = $CFG->langmenucachefile;
}
$singleton = new core_string_manager($CFG->langotherroot, $CFG->langlocalroot,
!empty($CFG->langstringcache), $translist, $langmenucache);
} else {
$singleton = new install_string_manager();
}
}
return $singleton;
}
/**
* Interface for string manager
*
* Interface describing class which is responsible for getting
* of localised strings from language packs.
*
* @package core
* @copyright 2010 Petr Skoda (http://skodak.org)
* @license http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/gpl.html GNU GPL v3 or later
*/
interface string_manager {
/**
* Get String returns a requested string
*
* @param string $identifier The identifier of the string to search for
* @param string $component The module the string is associated with
* @param string|object|array $a An object, string or number that can be used
* within translation strings
* @param string $lang moodle translation language, NULL means use current
* @return string The String !
*/
public function get_string($identifier, $component = '', $a = NULL, $lang = NULL);
/**
* Does the string actually exist?
*
* get_string() is throwing debug warnings, sometimes we do not want them
* or we want to display better explanation of the problem.
*
* Use with care!
*
* @param string $identifier The identifier of the string to search for
* @param string $component The module the string is associated with
* @return boot true if exists
*/
public function string_exists($identifier, $component);
/**
* Returns a localised list of all country names, sorted by country keys.
* @param bool $returnall return all or just enabled
* @param string $lang moodle translation language, NULL means use current
* @return array two-letter country code => translated name.
*/
public function get_list_of_countries($returnall = false, $lang = NULL);
/**
* Returns a localised list of languages, sorted by code keys.
*
* @param string $lang moodle translation language, NULL means use current
* @param string $standard language list standard
* iso6392: three-letter language code (ISO 639-2/T) => translated name.
* @return array language code => translated name
*/
public function get_list_of_languages($lang = NULL, $standard = 'iso6392');
/**
* Checks if the translation exists for the language
*
* @param string $lang moodle translation language code
* @param bool $includeall include also disabled translations
* @return bool true if exists
*/
public function translation_exists($lang, $includeall = true);
/**
* Returns localised list of installed translations
* @param bool $returnall return all or just enabled
* @return array moodle translation code => localised translation name
*/
public function get_list_of_translations($returnall = false);
/**
* Returns localised list of currencies.
*
* @param string $lang moodle translation language, NULL means use current
* @return array currency code => localised currency name
*/
public function get_list_of_currencies($lang = NULL);
/**
* Load all strings for one component
* @param string $component The module the string is associated with
* @param string $lang
* @param bool $disablecache Do not use caches, force fetching the strings from sources
* @param bool $disablelocal Do not use customized strings in xx_local language packs
* @return array of all string for given component and lang
*/
public function load_component_strings($component, $lang, $disablecache=false, $disablelocal=false);
/**
* Invalidates all caches, should the implementation use any
* @param bool $phpunitreset true means called from our PHPUnit integration test reset
*/
public function reset_caches($phpunitreset = false);
/**
* Returns string revision counter, this is incremented after any
* string cache reset.
* @return int lang string revision counter, -1 if unknown
*/
public function get_revision();
}
/**
* Standard string_manager implementation
*
* Implements string_manager with getting and printing localised strings
*
* @package core
* @category string
* @copyright 2010 Petr Skoda (http://skodak.org)
* @license http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/gpl.html GNU GPL v3 or later
*/
class core_string_manager implements string_manager {
/** @var string location of all packs except 'en' */
protected $otherroot;
/** @var string location of all lang pack local modifications */
protected $localroot;
/** @var cache lang string cache - it will be optimised more later */
protected $cache;
/** @var int get_string() counter */
protected $countgetstring = 0;
/** @var bool use disk cache */
protected $usecache;
/** @var array limit list of translations */
protected $translist;
/** @var string location of a file that caches the list of available translations */
protected $menucache;
/**
* Create new instance of string manager
*
* @param string $otherroot location of downlaoded lang packs - usually $CFG->dataroot/lang
* @param string $localroot usually the same as $otherroot
* @param bool $usecache use disk cache
* @param array $translist limit list of visible translations
* @param string $menucache the location of a file that caches the list of available translations
*/
public function __construct($otherroot, $localroot, $usecache, $translist, $menucache) {
$this->otherroot = $otherroot;
$this->localroot = $localroot;
$this->usecache = $usecache;
$this->translist = $translist;
$this->menucache = $menucache;
if ($this->usecache) {
// We can use a proper cache, establish the cache using the 'String cache' definition.
$this->cache = cache::make('core', 'string');
} else {
// We only want a cache for the length of the request, create a static cache.
$options = array(
'simplekeys' => true,
'simpledata' => true
);
$this->cache = cache::make_from_params(cache_store::MODE_REQUEST, 'core', 'string', array(), $options);
}
}
/**
* Returns list of all explicit parent languages for the given language.
*
* English (en) is considered as the top implicit parent of all language packs
* and is not included in the returned list. The language itself is appended to the
* end of the list. The method is aware of circular dependency risk.
*
* @see self::populate_parent_languages()
* @param string $lang the code of the language
* @return array all explicit parent languages with the lang itself appended
*/
public function get_language_dependencies($lang) {
return $this->populate_parent_languages($lang);
}
/**
* Load all strings for one component
*
* @param string $component The module the string is associated with
* @param string $lang
* @param bool $disablecache Do not use caches, force fetching the strings from sources
* @param bool $disablelocal Do not use customized strings in xx_local language packs
* @return array of all string for given component and lang
*/
public function load_component_strings($component, $lang, $disablecache=false, $disablelocal=false) {
global $CFG;
list($plugintype, $pluginname) = normalize_component($component);
if ($plugintype == 'core' and is_null($pluginname)) {
$component = 'core';
} else {
$component = $plugintype . '_' . $pluginname;
}
$cachekey = $lang.'_'.$component;
if (!$disablecache and !$disablelocal) {
$string = $this->cache->get($cachekey);
if ($string) {
return $string;
}
}
// no cache found - let us merge all possible sources of the strings
if ($plugintype === 'core') {
$file = $pluginname;
if ($file === null) {
$file = 'moodle';
}
$string = array();
// first load english pack
if (!file_exists("$CFG->dirroot/lang/en/$file.php")) {
return array();
}
include("$CFG->dirroot/lang/en/$file.php");
$originalkeys = array_keys($string);
$originalkeys = array_flip($originalkeys);
// and then corresponding local if present and allowed
if (!$disablelocal and file_exists("$this->localroot/en_local/$file.php")) {
include("$this->localroot/en_local/$file.php");
}
// now loop through all langs in correct order
$deps = $this->get_language_dependencies($lang);
foreach ($deps as $dep) {
// the main lang string location
if (file_exists("$this->otherroot/$dep/$file.php")) {
include("$this->otherroot/$dep/$file.php");
}
if (!$disablelocal and file_exists("$this->localroot/{$dep}_local/$file.php")) {
include("$this->localroot/{$dep}_local/$file.php");
}
}
} else {
if (!$location = get_plugin_directory($plugintype, $pluginname) or !is_dir($location)) {
return array();
}
if ($plugintype === 'mod') {
// bloody mod hack
$file = $pluginname;
} else {
$file = $plugintype . '_' . $pluginname;
}
$string = array();
// first load English pack
if (!file_exists("$location/lang/en/$file.php")) {
//English pack does not exist, so do not try to load anything else
return array();
}
include("$location/lang/en/$file.php");
$originalkeys = array_keys($string);
$originalkeys = array_flip($originalkeys);
// and then corresponding local english if present
if (!$disablelocal and file_exists("$this->localroot/en_local/$file.php")) {
include("$this->localroot/en_local/$file.php");
}
// now loop through all langs in correct order
$deps = $this->get_language_dependencies($lang);
foreach ($deps as $dep) {
// legacy location - used by contrib only
if (file_exists("$location/lang/$dep/$file.php")) {
include("$location/lang/$dep/$file.php");
}
// the main lang string location
if (file_exists("$this->otherroot/$dep/$file.php")) {
include("$this->otherroot/$dep/$file.php");
}
// local customisations
if (!$disablelocal and file_exists("$this->localroot/{$dep}_local/$file.php")) {
include("$this->localroot/{$dep}_local/$file.php");
}
}
}
// we do not want any extra strings from other languages - everything must be in en lang pack
$string = array_intersect_key($string, $originalkeys);
if (!$disablelocal) {
// now we have a list of strings from all possible sources. put it into both in-memory and on-disk
// caches so we do not need to do all this merging and dependencies resolving again
$this->cache->set($cachekey, $string);
}
return $string;
}
/**
* Does the string actually exist?
*
* get_string() is throwing debug warnings, sometimes we do not want them
* or we want to display better explanation of the problem.
* Note: Use with care!
*
* @param string $identifier The identifier of the string to search for
* @param string $component The module the string is associated with
* @return boot true if exists
*/
public function string_exists($identifier, $component) {
$identifier = clean_param($identifier, PARAM_STRINGID);
if (empty($identifier)) {
return false;
}
$lang = current_language();
$string = $this->load_component_strings($component, $lang);
return isset($string[$identifier]);
}
/**
* Get String returns a requested string
*
* @param string $identifier The identifier of the string to search for
* @param string $component The module the string is associated with
* @param string|object|array $a An object, string or number that can be used
* within translation strings
* @param string $lang moodle translation language, NULL means use current
* @return string The String !
*/
public function get_string($identifier, $component = '', $a = NULL, $lang = NULL) {
$this->countgetstring++;
// there are very many uses of these time formating strings without the 'langconfig' component,
// it would not be reasonable to expect that all of them would be converted during 2.0 migration
static $langconfigstrs = array(
'strftimedate' => 1,
'strftimedatefullshort' => 1,
'strftimedateshort' => 1,
'strftimedatetime' => 1,
'strftimedatetimeshort' => 1,
'strftimedaydate' => 1,
'strftimedaydatetime' => 1,
'strftimedayshort' => 1,
'strftimedaytime' => 1,
'strftimemonthyear' => 1,
'strftimerecent' => 1,
'strftimerecentfull' => 1,
'strftimetime' => 1);
if (empty($component)) {
if (isset($langconfigstrs[$identifier])) {
$component = 'langconfig';
} else {
$component = 'moodle';
}
}
if ($lang === NULL) {
$lang = current_language();
}
$string = $this->load_component_strings($component, $lang);
if (!isset($string[$identifier])) {
if ($component === 'pix' or $component === 'core_pix') {
// this component contains only alt tags for emoticons,
// not all of them are supposed to be defined
return '';
}
if ($identifier === 'parentlanguage' and ($component === 'langconfig' or $component === 'core_langconfig')) {
// parentlanguage is a special string, undefined means use English if not defined
return 'en';
}
if ($this->usecache) {
// maybe the on-disk cache is dirty - let the last attempt be to find the string in original sources,
// do NOT write the results to disk cache because it may end up in race conditions see MDL-31904
$this->usecache = false;
$string = $this->load_component_strings($component, $lang, true);
$this->usecache = true;
}
if (!isset($string[$identifier])) {
// the string is still missing - should be fixed by developer
list($plugintype, $pluginname) = normalize_component($component);
if ($plugintype == 'core') {
$file = "lang/en/{$component}.php";
} else if ($plugintype == 'mod') {
$file = "mod/{$pluginname}/lang/en/{$pluginname}.php";
} else {
$path = get_plugin_directory($plugintype, $pluginname);
$file = "{$path}/lang/en/{$plugintype}_{$pluginname}.php";
}
debugging("Invalid get_string() identifier: '{$identifier}' or component '{$component}'. " .
"Perhaps you are missing \$string['{$identifier}'] = ''; in {$file}?", DEBUG_DEVELOPER);
return "[[$identifier]]";
}
}
$string = $string[$identifier];
if ($a !== NULL) {
// Process array's and objects (except lang_strings)
if (is_array($a) or (is_object($a) && !($a instanceof lang_string))) {
$a = (array)$a;
$search = array();
$replace = array();
foreach ($a as $key=>$value) {
if (is_int($key)) {
// we do not support numeric keys - sorry!
continue;
}
if (is_array($value) or (is_object($value) && !($value instanceof lang_string))) {
// we support just string or lang_string as value
continue;
}
$search[] = '{$a->'.$key.'}';
$replace[] = (string)$value;
}
if ($search) {
$string = str_replace($search, $replace, $string);
}
} else {
$string = str_replace('{$a}', (string)$a, $string);
}
}
return $string;
}
/**
* Returns information about the string_manager performance
*
* @return array
*/
public function get_performance_summary() {
return array(array(
'langcountgetstring' => $this->countgetstring,
), array(
'langcountgetstring' => 'get_string calls',
));
}
/**
* Returns a localised list of all country names, sorted by localised name.
*
* @param bool $returnall return all or just enabled
* @param string $lang moodle translation language, NULL means use current
* @return array two-letter country code => translated name.
*/
public function get_list_of_countries($returnall = false, $lang = NULL) {
global $CFG;
if ($lang === NULL) {
$lang = current_language();
}
$countries = $this->load_component_strings('core_countries', $lang);
collatorlib::asort($countries);
if (!$returnall and !empty($CFG->allcountrycodes)) {
$enabled = explode(',', $CFG->allcountrycodes);
$return = array();
foreach ($enabled as $c) {
if (isset($countries[$c])) {
$return[$c] = $countries[$c];
}
}
return $return;
}
return $countries;
}
/**
* Returns a localised list of languages, sorted by code keys.
*
* @param string $lang moodle translation language, NULL means use current
* @param string $standard language list standard
* - iso6392: three-letter language code (ISO 639-2/T) => translated name
* - iso6391: two-letter langauge code (ISO 639-1) => translated name
* @return array language code => translated name
*/
public function get_list_of_languages($lang = NULL, $standard = 'iso6391') {
if ($lang === NULL) {
$lang = current_language();
}
if ($standard === 'iso6392') {
$langs = $this->load_component_strings('core_iso6392', $lang);
ksort($langs);
return $langs;
} else if ($standard === 'iso6391') {
$langs2 = $this->load_component_strings('core_iso6392', $lang);
static $mapping = array('aar' => 'aa', 'abk' => 'ab', 'afr' => 'af', 'aka' => 'ak', 'sqi' => 'sq', 'amh' => 'am', 'ara' => 'ar', 'arg' => 'an', 'hye' => 'hy',
'asm' => 'as', 'ava' => 'av', 'ave' => 'ae', 'aym' => 'ay', 'aze' => 'az', 'bak' => 'ba', 'bam' => 'bm', 'eus' => 'eu', 'bel' => 'be', 'ben' => 'bn', 'bih' => 'bh',
'bis' => 'bi', 'bos' => 'bs', 'bre' => 'br', 'bul' => 'bg', 'mya' => 'my', 'cat' => 'ca', 'cha' => 'ch', 'che' => 'ce', 'zho' => 'zh', 'chu' => 'cu', 'chv' => 'cv',
'cor' => 'kw', 'cos' => 'co', 'cre' => 'cr', 'ces' => 'cs', 'dan' => 'da', 'div' => 'dv', 'nld' => 'nl', 'dzo' => 'dz', 'eng' => 'en', 'epo' => 'eo', 'est' => 'et',
'ewe' => 'ee', 'fao' => 'fo', 'fij' => 'fj', 'fin' => 'fi', 'fra' => 'fr', 'fry' => 'fy', 'ful' => 'ff', 'kat' => 'ka', 'deu' => 'de', 'gla' => 'gd', 'gle' => 'ga',
'glg' => 'gl', 'glv' => 'gv', 'ell' => 'el', 'grn' => 'gn', 'guj' => 'gu', 'hat' => 'ht', 'hau' => 'ha', 'heb' => 'he', 'her' => 'hz', 'hin' => 'hi', 'hmo' => 'ho',
'hrv' => 'hr', 'hun' => 'hu', 'ibo' => 'ig', 'isl' => 'is', 'ido' => 'io', 'iii' => 'ii', 'iku' => 'iu', 'ile' => 'ie', 'ina' => 'ia', 'ind' => 'id', 'ipk' => 'ik',
'ita' => 'it', 'jav' => 'jv', 'jpn' => 'ja', 'kal' => 'kl', 'kan' => 'kn', 'kas' => 'ks', 'kau' => 'kr', 'kaz' => 'kk', 'khm' => 'km', 'kik' => 'ki', 'kin' => 'rw',
'kir' => 'ky', 'kom' => 'kv', 'kon' => 'kg', 'kor' => 'ko', 'kua' => 'kj', 'kur' => 'ku', 'lao' => 'lo', 'lat' => 'la', 'lav' => 'lv', 'lim' => 'li', 'lin' => 'ln',
'lit' => 'lt', 'ltz' => 'lb', 'lub' => 'lu', 'lug' => 'lg', 'mkd' => 'mk', 'mah' => 'mh', 'mal' => 'ml', 'mri' => 'mi', 'mar' => 'mr', 'msa' => 'ms', 'mlg' => 'mg',
'mlt' => 'mt', 'mon' => 'mn', 'nau' => 'na', 'nav' => 'nv', 'nbl' => 'nr', 'nde' => 'nd', 'ndo' => 'ng', 'nep' => 'ne', 'nno' => 'nn', 'nob' => 'nb', 'nor' => 'no',
'nya' => 'ny', 'oci' => 'oc', 'oji' => 'oj', 'ori' => 'or', 'orm' => 'om', 'oss' => 'os', 'pan' => 'pa', 'fas' => 'fa', 'pli' => 'pi', 'pol' => 'pl', 'por' => 'pt',
'pus' => 'ps', 'que' => 'qu', 'roh' => 'rm', 'ron' => 'ro', 'run' => 'rn', 'rus' => 'ru', 'sag' => 'sg', 'san' => 'sa', 'sin' => 'si', 'slk' => 'sk', 'slv' => 'sl',
'sme' => 'se', 'smo' => 'sm', 'sna' => 'sn', 'snd' => 'sd', 'som' => 'so', 'sot' => 'st', 'spa' => 'es', 'srd' => 'sc', 'srp' => 'sr', 'ssw' => 'ss', 'sun' => 'su',
'swa' => 'sw', 'swe' => 'sv', 'tah' => 'ty', 'tam' => 'ta', 'tat' => 'tt', 'tel' => 'te', 'tgk' => 'tg', 'tgl' => 'tl', 'tha' => 'th', 'bod' => 'bo', 'tir' => 'ti',
'ton' => 'to', 'tsn' => 'tn', 'tso' => 'ts', 'tuk' => 'tk', 'tur' => 'tr', 'twi' => 'tw', 'uig' => 'ug', 'ukr' => 'uk', 'urd' => 'ur', 'uzb' => 'uz', 'ven' => 've',
'vie' => 'vi', 'vol' => 'vo', 'cym' => 'cy', 'wln' => 'wa', 'wol' => 'wo', 'xho' => 'xh', 'yid' => 'yi', 'yor' => 'yo', 'zha' => 'za', 'zul' => 'zu');
$langs1 = array();
foreach ($mapping as $c2=>$c1) {
$langs1[$c1] = $langs2[$c2];
}
ksort($langs1);
return $langs1;
} else {
debugging('Unsupported $standard parameter in get_list_of_languages() method: '.$standard);
}
return array();
}
/**
* Checks if the translation exists for the language
*
* @param string $lang moodle translation language code
* @param bool $includeall include also disabled translations
* @return bool true if exists
*/
public function translation_exists($lang, $includeall = true) {
if (strpos($lang, '_local') !== false) {
// _local packs are not real translations
return false;
}
if (!$includeall and !empty($this->translist)) {
if (!in_array($lang, $this->translist)) {
return false;
}
}
if ($lang === 'en') {
// part of distribution
return true;
}
return file_exists("$this->otherroot/$lang/langconfig.php");
}
/**
* Returns localised list of installed translations
*
* @param bool $returnall return all or just enabled
* @return array moodle translation code => localised translation name
*/
public function get_list_of_translations($returnall = false) {
global $CFG;
$languages = array();
if (!empty($CFG->langcache) and is_readable($this->menucache)) {
// try to re-use the cached list of all available languages
$cachedlist = json_decode(file_get_contents($this->menucache), true);
if (is_array($cachedlist) and !empty($cachedlist)) {
// the cache file is restored correctly
if (!$returnall and !empty($this->translist)) {
// return just enabled translations
foreach ($cachedlist as $langcode => $langname) {
if (in_array($langcode, $this->translist)) {
$languages[$langcode] = $langname;
}
}
return $languages;
} else {
// return all translations
return $cachedlist;
}
}
}
// the cached list of languages is not available, let us populate the list
if (!$returnall and !empty($this->translist)) {
// return only some translations
foreach ($this->translist as $lang) {
$lang = trim($lang); //Just trim spaces to be a bit more permissive
if (strstr($lang, '_local') !== false) {
continue;
}
if (strstr($lang, '_utf8') !== false) {
continue;
}
if ($lang !== 'en' and !file_exists("$this->otherroot/$lang/langconfig.php")) {
// some broken or missing lang - can not switch to it anyway
continue;
}
$string = $this->load_component_strings('langconfig', $lang);
if (!empty($string['thislanguage'])) {
$languages[$lang] = $string['thislanguage'].' ('. $lang .')';
}
unset($string);
}
} else {
// return all languages available in system
$langdirs = get_list_of_plugins('', '', $this->otherroot);
$langdirs = array_merge($langdirs, array("$CFG->dirroot/lang/en"=>'en'));
// Sort all
// Loop through all langs and get info
foreach ($langdirs as $lang) {
if (strstr($lang, '_local') !== false) {
continue;
}
if (strstr($lang, '_utf8') !== false) {
continue;
}
$string = $this->load_component_strings('langconfig', $lang);
if (!empty($string['thislanguage'])) {
$languages[$lang] = $string['thislanguage'].' ('. $lang .')';
}
unset($string);
}
if (!empty($CFG->langcache) and !empty($this->menucache)) {
// cache the list so that it can be used next time
collatorlib::asort($languages);
check_dir_exists(dirname($this->menucache), true, true);
file_put_contents($this->menucache, json_encode($languages));
}
}
collatorlib::asort($languages);
return $languages;
}
/**
* Returns localised list of currencies.
*
* @param string $lang moodle translation language, NULL means use current
* @return array currency code => localised currency name
*/
public function get_list_of_currencies($lang = NULL) {
if ($lang === NULL) {
$lang = current_language();
}
$currencies = $this->load_component_strings('core_currencies', $lang);
asort($currencies);
return $currencies;
}
/**
* Clears both in-memory and on-disk caches
* @param bool $phpunitreset true means called from our PHPUnit integration test reset
*/
public function reset_caches($phpunitreset = false) {
global $CFG;
require_once("$CFG->libdir/filelib.php");
// clear the on-disk disk with aggregated string files
$this->cache->purge();
if (!$phpunitreset) {
// Increment the revision counter.
$langrev = get_config('core', 'langrev');
$next = time();
if ($langrev !== false and $next <= $langrev and $langrev - $next < 60*60) {
// This resolves problems when reset is requested repeatedly within 1s,
// the < 1h condition prevents accidental switching to future dates
// because we might not recover from it.
$next = $langrev+1;
}
set_config('langrev', $next);
}
// clear the cache containing the list of available translations
// and re-populate it again
fulldelete($this->menucache);
$this->get_list_of_translations(true);
}
/**
* Returns string revision counter, this is incremented after any
* string cache reset.
* @return int lang string revision counter, -1 if unknown
*/
public function get_revision() {
global $CFG;
if (isset($CFG->langrev)) {
return (int)$CFG->langrev;
} else {
return -1;
}
}
/// End of external API ////////////////////////////////////////////////////
/**
* Helper method that recursively loads all parents of the given language.
*
* @see self::get_language_dependencies()
* @param string $lang language code
* @param array $stack list of parent languages already populated in previous recursive calls
* @return array list of all parents of the given language with the $lang itself added as the last element
*/
protected function populate_parent_languages($lang, array $stack = array()) {
// English does not have a parent language.
if ($lang === 'en') {
return $stack;
}
// Prevent circular dependency (and thence the infinitive recursion loop).
if (in_array($lang, $stack)) {
return $stack;
}
// Load language configuration and look for the explicit parent language.
if (!file_exists("$this->otherroot/$lang/langconfig.php")) {
return $stack;
}
$string = array();
include("$this->otherroot/$lang/langconfig.php");
if (empty($string['parentlanguage']) or $string['parentlanguage'] === 'en') {
unset($string);
return array_merge(array($lang), $stack);
} else {
$parentlang = $string['parentlanguage'];
unset($string);
return $this->populate_parent_languages($parentlang, array_merge(array($lang), $stack));
}
}
}
/**
* Fetches minimum strings for installation
*
* Minimalistic string fetching implementation
* that is used in installer before we fetch the wanted
* language pack from moodle.org lang download site.
*
* @package core
* @copyright 2010 Petr Skoda (http://skodak.org)
* @license http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/gpl.html GNU GPL v3 or later
*/
class install_string_manager implements string_manager {
/** @var string location of pre-install packs for all langs */
protected $installroot;
/**
* Crate new instance of install string manager
*/
public function __construct() {
global $CFG;
$this->installroot = "$CFG->dirroot/install/lang";
}
/**
* Load all strings for one component
* @param string $component The module the string is associated with
* @param string $lang
* @param bool $disablecache Do not use caches, force fetching the strings from sources
* @param bool $disablelocal Do not use customized strings in xx_local language packs
* @return array of all string for given component and lang
*/
public function load_component_strings($component, $lang, $disablecache=false, $disablelocal=false) {
// not needed in installer
return array();
}
/**
* Does the string actually exist?
*
* get_string() is throwing debug warnings, sometimes we do not want them
* or we want to display better explanation of the problem.
*
* Use with care!
*
* @param string $identifier The identifier of the string to search for
* @param string $component The module the string is associated with
* @return boot true if exists
*/
public function string_exists($identifier, $component) {
$identifier = clean_param($identifier, PARAM_STRINGID);
if (empty($identifier)) {
return false;
}
// simple old style hack ;)
$str = get_string($identifier, $component);
return (strpos($str, '[[') === false);
}
/**
* Get String returns a requested string
*
* @param string $identifier The identifier of the string to search for
* @param string $component The module the string is associated with
* @param string|object|array $a An object, string or number that can be used
* within translation strings
* @param string $lang moodle translation language, NULL means use current
* @return string The String !
*/
public function get_string($identifier, $component = '', $a = NULL, $lang = NULL) {
if (!$component) {
$component = 'moodle';
}
if ($lang === NULL) {
$lang = current_language();
}
//get parent lang
$parent = '';
if ($lang !== 'en' and $identifier !== 'parentlanguage' and $component !== 'langconfig') {
if (file_exists("$this->installroot/$lang/langconfig.php")) {
$string = array();
include("$this->installroot/$lang/langconfig.php");
if (isset($string['parentlanguage'])) {
$parent = $string['parentlanguage'];
}
unset($string);
}
}
// include en string first
if (!file_exists("$this->installroot/en/$component.php")) {
return "[[$identifier]]";
}
$string = array();
include("$this->installroot/en/$component.php");
// now override en with parent if defined
if ($parent and $parent !== 'en' and file_exists("$this->installroot/$parent/$component.php")) {
include("$this->installroot/$parent/$component.php");
}
// finally override with requested language
if ($lang !== 'en' and file_exists("$this->installroot/$lang/$component.php")) {
include("$this->installroot/$lang/$component.php");
}
if (!isset($string[$identifier])) {
return "[[$identifier]]";
}
$string = $string[$identifier];
if ($a !== NULL) {
if (is_object($a) or is_array($a)) {
$a = (array)$a;
$search = array();
$replace = array();
foreach ($a as $key=>$value) {
if (is_int($key)) {
// we do not support numeric keys - sorry!
continue;
}
$search[] = '{$a->'.$key.'}';
$replace[] = (string)$value;
}
if ($search) {
$string = str_replace($search, $replace, $string);
}
} else {
$string = str_replace('{$a}', (string)$a, $string);
}
}
return $string;
}
/**
* Returns a localised list of all country names, sorted by country keys.
*
* @param bool $returnall return all or just enabled
* @param string $lang moodle translation language, NULL means use current
* @return array two-letter country code => translated name.
*/
public function get_list_of_countries($returnall = false, $lang = NULL) {
//not used in installer
return array();
}
/**
* Returns a localised list of languages, sorted by code keys.
*
* @param string $lang moodle translation language, NULL means use current
* @param string $standard language list standard
* iso6392: three-letter language code (ISO 639-2/T) => translated name.
* @return array language code => translated name
*/
public function get_list_of_languages($lang = NULL, $standard = 'iso6392') {
//not used in installer
return array();
}
/**
* Checks if the translation exists for the language
*
* @param string $lang moodle translation language code
* @param bool $includeall include also disabled translations
* @return bool true if exists
*/
public function translation_exists($lang, $includeall = true) {
return file_exists($this->installroot.'/'.$lang.'/langconfig.php');
}
/**
* Returns localised list of installed translations
* @param bool $returnall return all or just enabled
* @return array moodle translation code => localised translation name
*/
public function get_list_of_translations($returnall = false) {
// return all is ignored here - we need to know all langs in installer
$languages = array();
// Get raw list of lang directories
$langdirs = get_list_of_plugins('install/lang');
asort($langdirs);
// Get some info from each lang
foreach ($langdirs as $lang) {
if (file_exists($this->installroot.'/'.$lang.'/langconfig.php')) {
$string = array();
include($this->installroot.'/'.$lang.'/langconfig.php');
if (!empty($string['thislanguage'])) {
$languages[$lang] = $string['thislanguage'].' ('.$lang.')';
}
}
}
// Return array
return $languages;
}
/**
* Returns localised list of currencies.
*
* @param string $lang moodle translation language, NULL means use current
* @return array currency code => localised currency name
*/
public function get_list_of_currencies($lang = NULL) {
// not used in installer
return array();
}
/**
* This implementation does not use any caches
* @param bool $phpunitreset true means called from our PHPUnit integration test reset
*/
public function reset_caches($phpunitreset = false) {
// Nothing to do.
}
/**
* Returns string revision counter, this is incremented after any
* string cache reset.
* @return int lang string revision counter, -1 if unknown
*/
public function get_revision() {
return -1;
}
}
/**
* Returns a localized string.
*
* Returns the translated string specified by $identifier as
* for $module. Uses the same format files as STphp.
* $a is an object, string or number that can be used
* within translation strings
*
* eg 'hello {$a->firstname} {$a->lastname}'
* or 'hello {$a}'
*
* If you would like to directly echo the localized string use
* the function {@link print_string()}
*
* Example usage of this function involves finding the string you would
* like a local equivalent of and using its identifier and module information
* to retrieve it.<br/>
* If you open moodle/lang/en/moodle.php and look near line 278
* you will find a string to prompt a user for their word for 'course'
* <code>
* $string['course'] = 'Course';
* </code>
* So if you want to display the string 'Course'
* in any language that supports it on your site
* you just need to use the identifier 'course'
* <code>
* $mystring = '<strong>'. get_string('course') .'</strong>';
* or
* </code>
* If the string you want is in another file you'd take a slightly
* different approach. Looking in moodle/lang/en/calendar.php you find
* around line 75:
* <code>
* $string['typecourse'] = 'Course event';
* </code>
* If you want to display the string "Course event" in any language
* supported you would use the identifier 'typecourse' and the module 'calendar'
* (because it is in the file calendar.php):
* <code>
* $mystring = '<h1>'. get_string('typecourse', 'calendar') .'</h1>';
* </code>
*
* As a last resort, should the identifier fail to map to a string
* the returned string will be [[ $identifier ]]
*
* In Moodle 2.3 there is a new argument to this function $lazyload.
* Setting $lazyload to true causes get_string to return a lang_string object
* rather than the string itself. The fetching of the string is then put off until
* the string object is first used. The object can be used by calling it's out
* method or by casting the object to a string, either directly e.g.
* (string)$stringobject
* or indirectly by using the string within another string or echoing it out e.g.
* echo $stringobject
* return "<p>{$stringobject}</p>";
* It is worth noting that using $lazyload and attempting to use the string as an
* array key will cause a fatal error as objects cannot be used as array keys.
* But you should never do that anyway!
* For more information {@see lang_string}
*
* @category string
* @param string $identifier The key identifier for the localized string
* @param string $component The module where the key identifier is stored,
* usually expressed as the filename in the language pack without the
* .php on the end but can also be written as mod/forum or grade/export/xls.
* If none is specified then moodle.php is used.
* @param string|object|array $a An object, string or number that can be used
* within translation strings
* @param bool $lazyload If set to true a string object is returned instead of
* the string itself. The string then isn't calculated until it is first used.
* @return string The localized string.
*/
function get_string($identifier, $component = '', $a = NULL, $lazyload = false) {
global $CFG;
// If the lazy load argument has been supplied return a lang_string object
// instead.
// We need to make sure it is true (and a bool) as you will see below there
// used to be a forth argument at one point.
if ($lazyload === true) {
return new lang_string($identifier, $component, $a);
}
$identifier = clean_param($identifier, PARAM_STRINGID);
if (empty($identifier)) {
throw new coding_exception('Invalid string identifier. The identifier cannot be empty. Please fix your get_string() call.');
}
// There is now a forth argument again, this time it is a boolean however so
// we can still check for the old extralocations parameter.
if (!is_bool($lazyload) && !empty($lazyload)) {
debugging('extralocations parameter in get_string() is not supported any more, please use standard lang locations only.');
}
if (strpos($component, '/') !== false) {
debugging('The module name you passed to get_string is the deprecated format ' .
'like mod/mymod or block/myblock. The correct form looks like mymod, or block_myblock.' , DEBUG_DEVELOPER);
$componentpath = explode('/', $component);
switch ($componentpath[0]) {
case 'mod':
$component = $componentpath[1];
break;
case 'blocks':
case 'block':
$component = 'block_'.$componentpath[1];
break;
case 'enrol':
$component = 'enrol_'.$componentpath[1];
break;
case 'format':
$component = 'format_'.$componentpath[1];
break;
case 'grade':
$component = 'grade'.$componentpath[1].'_'.$componentpath[2];
break;
}
}
$result = get_string_manager()->get_string($identifier, $component, $a);
// Debugging feature lets you display string identifier and component
if (isset($CFG->debugstringids) && $CFG->debugstringids && optional_param('strings', 0, PARAM_INT)) {
$result .= ' {' . $identifier . '/' . $component . '}';
}
return $result;
}
/**
* Converts an array of strings to their localized value.
*
* @param array $array An array of strings
* @param string $component The language module that these strings can be found in.
* @return stdClass translated strings.
*/
function get_strings($array, $component = '') {
$string = new stdClass;
foreach ($array as $item) {
$string->$item = get_string($item, $component);
}
return $string;
}
/**
* Prints out a translated string.
*
* Prints out a translated string using the return value from the {@link get_string()} function.
*
* Example usage of this function when the string is in the moodle.php file:<br/>
* <code>
* echo '<strong>';
* print_string('course');
* echo '</strong>';
* </code>
*
* Example usage of this function when the string is not in the moodle.php file:<br/>
* <code>
* echo '<h1>';
* print_string('typecourse', 'calendar');
* echo '</h1>';
* </code>
*
* @category string
* @param string $identifier The key identifier for the localized string
* @param string $component The module where the key identifier is stored. If none is specified then moodle.php is used.
* @param string|object|array $a An object, string or number that can be used within translation strings
*/
function print_string($identifier, $component = '', $a = NULL) {
echo get_string($identifier, $component, $a);
}
/**
* Returns a list of charset codes
*
* Returns a list of charset codes. It's hardcoded, so they should be added manually
* (checking that such charset is supported by the texlib library!)
*
* @return array And associative array with contents in the form of charset => charset
*/
function get_list_of_charsets() {
$charsets = array(
'EUC-JP' => 'EUC-JP',
'ISO-2022-JP'=> 'ISO-2022-JP',
'ISO-8859-1' => 'ISO-8859-1',
'SHIFT-JIS' => 'SHIFT-JIS',
'GB2312' => 'GB2312',
'GB18030' => 'GB18030', // gb18030 not supported by typo and mbstring
'UTF-8' => 'UTF-8');
asort($charsets);
return $charsets;
}
/**
* Returns a list of valid and compatible themes
*
* @return array
*/
function get_list_of_themes() {
global $CFG;
$themes = array();
if (!empty($CFG->themelist)) { // use admin's list of themes
$themelist = explode(',', $CFG->themelist);
} else {
$themelist = array_keys(get_plugin_list("theme"));
}
foreach ($themelist as $key => $themename) {
$theme = theme_config::load($themename);
$themes[$themename] = $theme;
}
collatorlib::asort_objects_by_method($themes, 'get_theme_name');
return $themes;
}
/**
* Returns a list of timezones in the current language
*
* @global object
* @global object
* @return array
*/
function get_list_of_timezones() {
global $CFG, $DB;
static $timezones;
if (!empty($timezones)) { // This function has been called recently
return $timezones;
}
$timezones = array();
if ($rawtimezones = $DB->get_records_sql("SELECT MAX(id), name FROM {timezone} GROUP BY name")) {
foreach($rawtimezones as $timezone) {
if (!empty($timezone->name)) {
if (get_string_manager()->string_exists(strtolower($timezone->name), 'timezones')) {
$timezones[$timezone->name] = get_string(strtolower($timezone->name), 'timezones');
} else {
$timezones[$timezone->name] = $timezone->name;
}
if (substr($timezones[$timezone->name], 0, 1) == '[') { // No translation found
$timezones[$timezone->name] = $timezone->name;
}
}
}
}
asort($timezones);
for ($i = -13; $i <= 13; $i += .5) {
$tzstring = 'UTC';
if ($i < 0) {
$timezones[sprintf("%.1f", $i)] = $tzstring . $i;
} else if ($i > 0) {
$timezones[sprintf("%.1f", $i)] = $tzstring . '+' . $i;
} else {
$timezones[sprintf("%.1f", $i)] = $tzstring;
}
}
return $timezones;
}
/**
* Factory function for emoticon_manager
*
* @return emoticon_manager singleton
*/
function get_emoticon_manager() {
static $singleton = null;
if (is_null($singleton)) {
$singleton = new emoticon_manager();
}
return $singleton;
}
/**
* Provides core support for plugins that have to deal with
* emoticons (like HTML editor or emoticon filter).
*
* Whenever this manager mentiones 'emoticon object', the following data
* structure is expected: stdClass with properties text, imagename, imagecomponent,
* altidentifier and altcomponent
*
* @see admin_setting_emoticons
*/
class emoticon_manager {
/**
* Returns the currently enabled emoticons
*
* @return array of emoticon objects
*/
public function get_emoticons() {
global $CFG;
if (empty($CFG->emoticons)) {
return array();
}
$emoticons = $this->decode_stored_config($CFG->emoticons);
if (!is_array($emoticons)) {
// something is wrong with the format of stored setting
debugging('Invalid format of emoticons setting, please resave the emoticons settings form', DEBUG_NORMAL);
return array();
}
return $emoticons;
}
/**
* Converts emoticon object into renderable pix_emoticon object
*
* @param stdClass $emoticon emoticon object
* @param array $attributes explicit HTML attributes to set
* @return pix_emoticon
*/
public function prepare_renderable_emoticon(stdClass $emoticon, array $attributes = array()) {
$stringmanager = get_string_manager();
if ($stringmanager->string_exists($emoticon->altidentifier, $emoticon->altcomponent)) {
$alt = get_string($emoticon->altidentifier, $emoticon->altcomponent);
} else {
$alt = s($emoticon->text);
}
return new pix_emoticon($emoticon->imagename, $alt, $emoticon->imagecomponent, $attributes);
}
/**
* Encodes the array of emoticon objects into a string storable in config table
*
* @see self::decode_stored_config()
* @param array $emoticons array of emtocion objects
* @return string
*/
public function encode_stored_config(array $emoticons) {
return json_encode($emoticons);
}
/**
* Decodes the string into an array of emoticon objects
*
* @see self::encode_stored_config()
* @param string $encoded
* @return string|null
*/
public function decode_stored_config($encoded) {
$decoded = json_decode($encoded);
if (!is_array($decoded)) {
return null;
}
return $decoded;
}
/**
* Returns default set of emoticons supported by Moodle
*
* @return array of sdtClasses
*/
public function default_emoticons() {
return array(
$this->prepare_emoticon_object(":-)", 's/smiley', 'smiley'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object(":)", 's/smiley', 'smiley'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object(":-D", 's/biggrin', 'biggrin'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object(";-)", 's/wink', 'wink'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object(":-/", 's/mixed', 'mixed'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object("V-.", 's/thoughtful', 'thoughtful'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object(":-P", 's/tongueout', 'tongueout'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object(":-p", 's/tongueout', 'tongueout'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object("B-)", 's/cool', 'cool'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object("^-)", 's/approve', 'approve'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object("8-)", 's/wideeyes', 'wideeyes'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object(":o)", 's/clown', 'clown'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object(":-(", 's/sad', 'sad'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object(":(", 's/sad', 'sad'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object("8-.", 's/shy', 'shy'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object(":-I", 's/blush', 'blush'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object(":-X", 's/kiss', 'kiss'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object("8-o", 's/surprise', 'surprise'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object("P-|", 's/blackeye', 'blackeye'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object("8-[", 's/angry', 'angry'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object("(grr)", 's/angry', 'angry'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object("xx-P", 's/dead', 'dead'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object("|-.", 's/sleepy', 'sleepy'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object("}-]", 's/evil', 'evil'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object("(h)", 's/heart', 'heart'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object("(heart)", 's/heart', 'heart'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object("(y)", 's/yes', 'yes', 'core'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object("(n)", 's/no', 'no', 'core'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object("(martin)", 's/martin', 'martin'),
$this->prepare_emoticon_object("( )", 's/egg', 'egg'),
);
}
/**
* Helper method preparing the stdClass with the emoticon properties
*
* @param string|array $text or array of strings
* @param string $imagename to be used by {@see pix_emoticon}
* @param string $altidentifier alternative string identifier, null for no alt
* @param array $altcomponent where the alternative string is defined
* @param string $imagecomponent to be used by {@see pix_emoticon}
* @return stdClass
*/
protected function prepare_emoticon_object($text, $imagename, $altidentifier = null, $altcomponent = 'core_pix', $imagecomponent = 'core') {
return (object)array(
'text' => $text,
'imagename' => $imagename,
'imagecomponent' => $imagecomponent,
'altidentifier' => $altidentifier,
'altcomponent' => $altcomponent,
);
}
}
/// ENCRYPTION ////////////////////////////////////////////////
/**
* rc4encrypt
*
* Please note that in this version of moodle that the default for rc4encryption is
* using the slightly more secure password key. There may be an issue when upgrading
* from an older version of moodle.
*
* @todo MDL-31836 Remove the old password key in version 2.4
* Code also needs to be changed in sessionlib.php
* @see get_moodle_cookie()
* @see set_moodle_cookie()
*
* @param string $data Data to encrypt.
* @param bool $usesecurekey Lets us know if we are using the old or new secure password key.
* @return string The now encrypted data.
*/
function rc4encrypt($data, $usesecurekey = true) {
if (!$usesecurekey) {
$passwordkey = 'nfgjeingjk';
} else {
$passwordkey = get_site_identifier();
}
return endecrypt($passwordkey, $data, '');
}
/**
* rc4decrypt
*
* Please note that in this version of moodle that the default for rc4encryption is
* using the slightly more secure password key. There may be an issue when upgrading
* from an older version of moodle.
*
* @todo MDL-31836 Remove the old password key in version 2.4
* Code also needs to be changed in sessionlib.php
* @see get_moodle_cookie()
* @see set_moodle_cookie()
*
* @param string $data Data to decrypt.
* @param bool $usesecurekey Lets us know if we are using the old or new secure password key.
* @return string The now decrypted data.
*/
function rc4decrypt($data, $usesecurekey = true) {
if (!$usesecurekey) {
$passwordkey = 'nfgjeingjk';
} else {
$passwordkey = get_site_identifier();
}
return endecrypt($passwordkey, $data, 'de');
}
/**
* Based on a class by Mukul Sabharwal [mukulsabharwal @ yahoo.com]
*
* @todo Finish documenting this function
*
* @param string $pwd The password to use when encrypting or decrypting
* @param string $data The data to be decrypted/encrypted
* @param string $case Either 'de' for decrypt or '' for encrypt
* @return string
*/
function endecrypt ($pwd, $data, $case) {
if ($case == 'de') {
$data = urldecode($data);
}
$key[] = '';
$box[] = '';
$temp_swap = '';
$pwd_length = 0;
$pwd_length = strlen($pwd);
for ($i = 0; $i <= 255; $i++) {
$key[$i] = ord(substr($pwd, ($i % $pwd_length), 1));
$box[$i] = $i;
}
$x = 0;
for ($i = 0; $i <= 255; $i++) {
$x = ($x + $box[$i] + $key[$i]) % 256;
$temp_swap = $box[$i];
$box[$i] = $box[$x];
$box[$x] = $temp_swap;
}
$temp = '';
$k = '';
$cipherby = '';
$cipher = '';
$a = 0;
$j = 0;
for ($i = 0; $i < strlen($data); $i++) {
$a = ($a + 1) % 256;
$j = ($j + $box[$a]) % 256;
$temp = $box[$a];
$box[$a] = $box[$j];
$box[$j] = $temp;
$k = $box[(($box[$a] + $box[$j]) % 256)];
$cipherby = ord(substr($data, $i, 1)) ^ $k;
$cipher .= chr($cipherby);
}
if ($case == 'de') {
$cipher = urldecode(urlencode($cipher));
} else {
$cipher = urlencode($cipher);
}
return $cipher;
}
/// ENVIRONMENT CHECKING ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
/**
* Returns the exact absolute path to plugin directory.
*
* @param string $plugintype type of plugin
* @param string $name name of the plugin
* @return string full path to plugin directory; NULL if not found
*/
function get_plugin_directory($plugintype, $name) {
global $CFG;
if ($plugintype === '') {
$plugintype = 'mod';
}
$types = get_plugin_types(true);
if (!array_key_exists($plugintype, $types)) {
return NULL;
}
$name = clean_param($name, PARAM_SAFEDIR); // just in case ;-)
if (!empty($CFG->themedir) and $plugintype === 'theme') {
if (!is_dir($types['theme'] . '/' . $name)) {
// ok, so the theme is supposed to be in the $CFG->themedir
return $CFG->themedir . '/' . $name;
}
}
return $types[$plugintype].'/'.$name;
}
/**
* Return exact absolute path to a plugin directory.
*
* @param string $component name such as 'moodle', 'mod_forum'
* @return string full path to component directory; NULL if not found
*/
function get_component_directory($component) {
global $CFG;
list($type, $plugin) = normalize_component($component);
if ($type === 'core') {
if ($plugin === NULL ) {
$path = $CFG->libdir;
} else {
$subsystems = get_core_subsystems();
if (isset($subsystems[$plugin])) {
$path = $CFG->dirroot.'/'.$subsystems[$plugin];
} else {
$path = NULL;
}
}
} else {
$path = get_plugin_directory($type, $plugin);
}
return $path;
}
/**
* Normalize the component name using the "frankenstyle" names.
* @param string $component
* @return array $type+$plugin elements
*/
function normalize_component($component) {
if ($component === 'moodle' or $component === 'core') {
$type = 'core';
$plugin = NULL;
} else if (strpos($component, '_') === false) {
$subsystems = get_core_subsystems();
if (array_key_exists($component, $subsystems)) {
$type = 'core';
$plugin = $component;
} else {
// everything else is a module
$type = 'mod';
$plugin = $component;
}
} else {
list($type, $plugin) = explode('_', $component, 2);
$plugintypes = get_plugin_types(false);
if ($type !== 'core' and !array_key_exists($type, $plugintypes)) {
$type = 'mod';
$plugin = $component;
}
}
return array($type, $plugin);
}
/**
* List all core subsystems and their location
*
* This is a whitelist of components that are part of the core and their
* language strings are defined in /lang/en/<<subsystem>>.php. If a given
* plugin is not listed here and it does not have proper plugintype prefix,
* then it is considered as course activity module.
*
* The location is dirroot relative path. NULL means there is no special
* directory for this subsystem. If the location is set, the subsystem's
* renderer.php is expected to be there.
*
* @return array of (string)name => (string|null)location
*/
function get_core_subsystems() {
global $CFG;
static $info = null;
if (!$info) {
$info = array(
'access' => NULL,
'admin' => $CFG->admin,
'auth' => 'auth',
'backup' => 'backup/util/ui',
'badges' => 'badges',
'block' => 'blocks',
'blog' => 'blog',
'bulkusers' => NULL,
'cache' => 'cache',
'calendar' => 'calendar',
'cohort' => 'cohort',
'condition' => NULL,
'completion' => NULL,
'countries' => NULL,
'course' => 'course',
'currencies' => NULL,
'dbtransfer' => NULL,
'debug' => NULL,
'dock' => NULL,
'editor' => 'lib/editor',
'edufields' => NULL,
'enrol' => 'enrol',
'error' => NULL,
'filepicker' => NULL,
'files' => 'files',
'filters' => NULL,
'fonts' => NULL,
'form' => 'lib/form',
'grades' => 'grade',
'grading' => 'grade/grading',
'group' => 'group',
'help' => NULL,
'hub' => NULL,
'imscc' => NULL,
'install' => NULL,
'iso6392' => NULL,
'langconfig' => NULL,
'license' => NULL,
'mathslib' => NULL,
'media' => 'media',
'message' => 'message',
'mimetypes' => NULL,
'mnet' => 'mnet',
'moodle.org' => NULL, // the dot is nasty, watch out! should be renamed to moodleorg
'my' => 'my',
'notes' => 'notes',
'pagetype' => NULL,
'pix' => NULL,
'plagiarism' => 'plagiarism',
'plugin' => NULL,
'portfolio' => 'portfolio',
'publish' => 'course/publish',
'question' => 'question',
'rating' => 'rating',
'register' => 'admin/registration', //TODO: this is wrong, unfortunately we would need to modify hub code to pass around the correct url
'repository' => 'repository',
'rss' => 'rss',
'role' => $CFG->admin.'/role',
'search' => 'search',
'table' => NULL,
'tag' => 'tag',
'timezones' => NULL,
'user' => 'user',
'userkey' => NULL,
'webservice' => 'webservice',
);
}
return $info;
}
/**
* Lists all plugin types
* @param bool $fullpaths false means relative paths from dirroot
* @return array Array of strings - name=>location
*/
function get_plugin_types($fullpaths=true) {
global $CFG;
$cache = cache::make('core', 'plugintypes');
if ($fullpaths) {
$cached = $cache->get(1);
} else {
$cached = $cache->get(0);
}
if ($cached !== false) {
return $cached;
} else {
$info = array('qtype' => 'question/type',
'mod' => 'mod',
'auth' => 'auth',
'enrol' => 'enrol',
'message' => 'message/output',
'block' => 'blocks',
'filter' => 'filter',
'editor' => 'lib/editor',
'format' => 'course/format',
'profilefield' => 'user/profile/field',
'report' => 'report',
'coursereport' => 'course/report', // must be after system reports
'gradeexport' => 'grade/export',
'gradeimport' => 'grade/import',
'gradereport' => 'grade/report',
'gradingform' => 'grade/grading/form',
'mnetservice' => 'mnet/service',
'webservice' => 'webservice',
'repository' => 'repository',
'portfolio' => 'portfolio',
'qbehaviour' => 'question/behaviour',
'qformat' => 'question/format',
'plagiarism' => 'plagiarism',
'tool' => $CFG->admin.'/tool',
'cachestore' => 'cache/stores',
'cachelock' => 'cache/locks',
'theme' => 'theme', // this is a bit hacky, themes may be in $CFG->themedir too
);
$subpluginowners = array_merge(array_values(get_plugin_list('mod')),
array_values(get_plugin_list('editor')));
foreach ($subpluginowners as $ownerdir) {
if (file_exists("$ownerdir/db/subplugins.php")) {
$subplugins = array();
include("$ownerdir/db/subplugins.php");
foreach ($subplugins as $subtype=>$dir) {
$info[$subtype] = $dir;
}
}
}
// local is always last!
$info['local'] = 'local';
$fullinfo = array();
foreach ($info as $type => $dir) {
$fullinfo[$type] = $CFG->dirroot.'/'.$dir;
}
$cache->set(0, $info);
$cache->set(1, $fullinfo);
return ($fullpaths ? $fullinfo : $info);
}
}
/**
* Simplified version of get_list_of_plugins()
* @param string $plugintype type of plugin
* @return array name=>fulllocation pairs of plugins of given type
*/
function get_plugin_list($plugintype) {
global $CFG;
$cache = cache::make('core', 'pluginlist');
$cached = $cache->get($plugintype);
if ($cached !== false) {
return $cached;
}
$ignored = array('CVS', '_vti_cnf', 'simpletest', 'db', 'yui', 'tests');
if ($plugintype == 'auth') {
// Historically we have had an auth plugin called 'db', so allow a special case.
$key = array_search('db', $ignored);
if ($key !== false) {
unset($ignored[$key]);
}
}
if ($plugintype === '') {
$plugintype = 'mod';
}
$fulldirs = array();
if ($plugintype === 'mod') {
// mod is an exception because we have to call this function from get_plugin_types()
$fulldirs[] = $CFG->dirroot.'/mod';
} else if ($plugintype === 'editor') {
// Exception also needed for editor for same reason.
$fulldirs[] = $CFG->dirroot . '/lib/editor';
} else if ($plugintype === 'theme') {
$fulldirs[] = $CFG->dirroot.'/theme';
// themes are special because they may be stored also in separate directory
if (!empty($CFG->themedir) and file_exists($CFG->themedir) and is_dir($CFG->themedir) ) {
$fulldirs[] = $CFG->themedir;
}
} else {
$types = get_plugin_types(true);
if (!array_key_exists($plugintype, $types)) {
$cache->set($plugintype, array());
return array();
}
$fulldir = $types[$plugintype];
if (!file_exists($fulldir)) {
$cache->set($plugintype, array());
return array();
}
$fulldirs[] = $fulldir;
}
$result = array();
foreach ($fulldirs as $fulldir) {
if (!is_dir($fulldir)) {
continue;
}
$items = new DirectoryIterator($fulldir);
foreach ($items as $item) {
if ($item->isDot() or !$item->isDir()) {
continue;
}
$pluginname = $item->getFilename();
if (in_array($pluginname, $ignored)) {
continue;
}
$pluginname = clean_param($pluginname, PARAM_PLUGIN);
if (empty($pluginname)) {
// better ignore plugins with problematic names here
continue;
}
$result[$pluginname] = $fulldir.'/'.$pluginname;
unset($item);
}
unset($items);
}
//TODO: implement better sorting once we migrated all plugin names to 'pluginname', ksort does not work for unicode, that is why we have to sort by the dir name, not the strings!
ksort($result);
$cache->set($plugintype, $result);
return $result;
}
/**
* Get a list of all the plugins of a given type that contain a particular file.
* @param string $plugintype the type of plugin, e.g. 'mod' or 'report'.
* @param string $file the name of file that must be present in the plugin.
* (e.g. 'view.php', 'db/install.xml').
* @param bool $include if true (default false), the file will be include_once-ed if found.
* @return array with plugin name as keys (e.g. 'forum', 'courselist') and the path
* to the file relative to dirroot as value (e.g. "$CFG->dirroot/mod/forum/view.php").
*/
function get_plugin_list_with_file($plugintype, $file, $include = false) {
global $CFG; // Necessary in case it is referenced by include()d PHP scripts.
$plugins = array();
foreach(get_plugin_list($plugintype) as $plugin => $dir) {
$path = $dir . '/' . $file;
if (file_exists($path)) {
if ($include) {
include_once($path);
}
$plugins[$plugin] = $path;
}
}
return $plugins;
}
/**
* Get a list of all the plugins of a given type that define a certain API function
* in a certain file. The plugin component names and function names are returned.
*
* @param string $plugintype the type of plugin, e.g. 'mod' or 'report'.
* @param string $function the part of the name of the function after the
* frankenstyle prefix. e.g 'hook' if you are looking for functions with
* names like report_courselist_hook.
* @param string $file the name of file within the plugin that defines the
* function. Defaults to lib.php.
* @return array with frankenstyle plugin names as keys (e.g. 'report_courselist', 'mod_forum')
* and the function names as values (e.g. 'report_courselist_hook', 'forum_hook').
*/
function get_plugin_list_with_function($plugintype, $function, $file = 'lib.php') {
$pluginfunctions = array();
foreach (get_plugin_list_with_file($plugintype, $file, true) as $plugin => $notused) {
$fullfunction = $plugintype . '_' . $plugin . '_' . $function;
if (function_exists($fullfunction)) {
// Function exists with standard name. Store, indexed by
// frankenstyle name of plugin
$pluginfunctions[$plugintype . '_' . $plugin] = $fullfunction;
} else if ($plugintype === 'mod') {
// For modules, we also allow plugin without full frankenstyle
// but just starting with the module name
$shortfunction = $plugin . '_' . $function;
if (function_exists($shortfunction)) {
$pluginfunctions[$plugintype . '_' . $plugin] = $shortfunction;
}
}
}
return $pluginfunctions;
}
/**
* Get a list of all the plugins of a given type that define a certain class
* in a certain file. The plugin component names and class names are returned.
*
* @param string $plugintype the type of plugin, e.g. 'mod' or 'report'.
* @param string $class the part of the name of the class after the
* frankenstyle prefix. e.g 'thing' if you are looking for classes with
* names like report_courselist_thing. If you are looking for classes with
* the same name as the plugin name (e.g. qtype_multichoice) then pass ''.
* @param string $file the name of file within the plugin that defines the class.
* @return array with frankenstyle plugin names as keys (e.g. 'report_courselist', 'mod_forum')
* and the class names as values (e.g. 'report_courselist_thing', 'qtype_multichoice').
*/
function get_plugin_list_with_class($plugintype, $class, $file) {
if ($class) {
$suffix = '_' . $class;
} else {
$suffix = '';
}
$pluginclasses = array();
foreach (get_plugin_list_with_file($plugintype, $file, true) as $plugin => $notused) {
$classname = $plugintype . '_' . $plugin . $suffix;
if (class_exists($classname)) {
$pluginclasses[$plugintype . '_' . $plugin] = $classname;
}
}
return $pluginclasses;
}
/**
* Lists plugin-like directories within specified directory
*
* This function was originally used for standard Moodle plugins, please use
* new get_plugin_list() now.
*
* This function is used for general directory listing and backwards compatility.
*
* @param string $directory relative directory from root
* @param string $exclude dir name to exclude from the list (defaults to none)
* @param string $basedir full path to the base dir where $plugin resides (defaults to $CFG->dirroot)
* @return array Sorted array of directory names found under the requested parameters
*/
function get_list_of_plugins($directory='mod', $exclude='', $basedir='') {
global $CFG;
$plugins = array();
if (empty($basedir)) {
$basedir = $CFG->dirroot .'/'. $directory;
} else {
$basedir = $basedir .'/'. $directory;
}
if (file_exists($basedir) && filetype($basedir) == 'dir') {
if (!$dirhandle = opendir($basedir)) {
debugging("Directory permission error for plugin ({$directory}). Directory exists but cannot be read.", DEBUG_DEVELOPER);
return array();
}
while (false !== ($dir = readdir($dirhandle))) {
$firstchar = substr($dir, 0, 1);
if ($firstchar === '.' or $dir === 'CVS' or $dir === '_vti_cnf' or $dir === 'simpletest' or $dir === 'yui' or $dir === 'phpunit' or $dir === $exclude) {
continue;
}
if (filetype($basedir .'/'. $dir) != 'dir') {
continue;
}
$plugins[] = $dir;
}
closedir($dirhandle);
}
if ($plugins) {
asort($plugins);
}
return $plugins;
}
/**
* Invoke plugin's callback functions
*
* @param string $type plugin type e.g. 'mod'
* @param string $name plugin name
* @param string $feature feature name
* @param string $action feature's action
* @param array $params parameters of callback function, should be an array
* @param mixed $default default value if callback function hasn't been defined, or if it retursn null.
* @return mixed
*
* @todo Decide about to deprecate and drop plugin_callback() - MDL-30743
*/
function plugin_callback($type, $name, $feature, $action, $params = null, $default = null) {
return component_callback($type . '_' . $name, $feature . '_' . $action, (array) $params, $default);
}
/**
* Invoke component's callback functions
*
* @param string $component frankenstyle component name, e.g. 'mod_quiz'
* @param string $function the rest of the function name, e.g. 'cron' will end up calling 'mod_quiz_cron'
* @param array $params parameters of callback function
* @param mixed $default default value if callback function hasn't been defined, or if it retursn null.
* @return mixed
*/
function component_callback($component, $function, array $params = array(), $default = null) {
global $CFG; // this is needed for require_once() below
$cleancomponent = clean_param($component, PARAM_COMPONENT);
if (empty($cleancomponent)) {
throw new coding_exception('Invalid component used in plugin/component_callback():' . $component);
}
$component = $cleancomponent;
list($type, $name) = normalize_component($component);
$component = $type . '_' . $name;
$oldfunction = $name.'_'.$function;
$function = $component.'_'.$function;
$dir = get_component_directory($component);
if (empty($dir)) {
throw new coding_exception('Invalid component used in plugin/component_callback():' . $component);
}
// Load library and look for function
if (file_exists($dir.'/lib.php')) {
require_once($dir.'/lib.php');
}
if (!function_exists($function) and function_exists($oldfunction)) {
if ($type !== 'mod' and $type !== 'core') {
debugging("Please use new function name $function instead of legacy $oldfunction");
}
$function = $oldfunction;
}
if (function_exists($function)) {
// Function exists, so just return function result
$ret = call_user_func_array($function, $params);
if (is_null($ret)) {
return $default;
} else {
return $ret;
}
}
return $default;
}
/**
* Checks whether a plugin supports a specified feature.
*
* @param string $type Plugin type e.g. 'mod'
* @param string $name Plugin name e.g. 'forum'
* @param string $feature Feature code (FEATURE_xx constant)
* @param mixed $default default value if feature support unknown
* @return mixed Feature result (false if not supported, null if feature is unknown,
* otherwise usually true but may have other feature-specific value such as array)
*/
function plugin_supports($type, $name, $feature, $default = NULL) {
global $CFG;
if ($type === 'mod' and $name === 'NEWMODULE') {
//somebody forgot to rename the module template
return false;
}
$component = clean_param($type . '_' . $name, PARAM_COMPONENT);
if (empty($component)) {
throw new coding_exception('Invalid component used in plugin_supports():' . $type . '_' . $name);
}
$function = null;
if ($type === 'mod') {
// we need this special case because we support subplugins in modules,
// otherwise it would end up in infinite loop
if (file_exists("$CFG->dirroot/mod/$name/lib.php")) {
include_once("$CFG->dirroot/mod/$name/lib.php");
$function = $component.'_supports';
if (!function_exists($function)) {
// legacy non-frankenstyle function name
$function = $name.'_supports';
}
} else {
// invalid module
}
} else {
if (!$path = get_plugin_directory($type, $name)) {
// non existent plugin type
return false;
}
if (file_exists("$path/lib.php")) {
include_once("$path/lib.php");
$function = $component.'_supports';
}
}
if ($function and function_exists($function)) {
$supports = $function($feature);
if (is_null($supports)) {
// plugin does not know - use default
return $default;
} else {
return $supports;
}
}
//plugin does not care, so use default
return $default;
}
/**
* Returns true if the current version of PHP is greater that the specified one.
*
* @todo Check PHP version being required here is it too low?
*
* @param string $version The version of php being tested.
* @return bool
*/
function check_php_version($version='5.2.4') {
return (version_compare(phpversion(), $version) >= 0);
}
/**
* Checks to see if is the browser operating system matches the specified
* brand.
*
* Known brand: 'Windows','Linux','Macintosh','SGI','SunOS','HP-UX'
*
* @uses $_SERVER
* @param string $brand The operating system identifier being tested
* @return bool true if the given brand below to the detected operating system
*/
function check_browser_operating_system($brand) {
if (empty($_SERVER['HTTP_USER_AGENT'])) {
return false;
}
if (preg_match("/$brand/i", $_SERVER['HTTP_USER_AGENT'])) {
return true;
}
return false;
}
/**
* Checks to see if is a browser matches the specified
* brand and is equal or better version.
*
* @uses $_SERVER
* @param string $brand The browser identifier being tested
* @param int $version The version of the browser, if not specified any version (except 5.5 for IE for BC reasons)
* @return bool true if the given version is below that of the detected browser
*/
function check_browser_version($brand, $version = null) {
if (empty($_SERVER['HTTP_USER_AGENT'])) {
return false;
}
$agent = $_SERVER['HTTP_USER_AGENT'];
switch ($brand) {
case 'Camino': /// OSX browser using Gecke engine
if (strpos($agent, 'Camino') === false) {
return false;
}
if (empty($version)) {
return true; // no version specified
}
if (preg_match("/Camino\/([0-9\.]+)/i", $agent, $match)) {
if (version_compare($match[1], $version) >= 0) {
return true;
}
}
break;
case 'Firefox': /// Mozilla Firefox browsers
if (strpos($agent, 'Iceweasel') === false and strpos($agent, 'Firefox') === false) {
return false;
}
if (empty($version)) {
return true; // no version specified
}
if (preg_match("/(Iceweasel|Firefox)\/([0-9\.]+)/i", $agent, $match)) {
if (version_compare($match[2], $version) >= 0) {
return true;
}
}
break;
case 'Gecko': /// Gecko based browsers
// Do not look for dates any more, we expect real Firefox version here.
if (empty($version)) {
$version = 1;
} else if ($version > 20000000) {
// This is just a guess, it is not supposed to be 100% accurate!
if (preg_match('/^201/', $version)) {
$version = 3.6;
} else if (preg_match('/^200[7-9]/', $version)) {
$version = 3;
} else if (preg_match('/^2006/', $version)) {
$version = 2;
} else {
$version = 1.5;
}
}
if (preg_match("/(Iceweasel|Firefox)\/([0-9\.]+)/i", $agent, $match)) {
// Use real Firefox version if specified in user agent string.
if (version_compare($match[2], $version) >= 0) {
return true;
}
} else if (preg_match("/Gecko\/([0-9\.]+)/i", $agent, $match)) {
// Gecko might contain date or Firefox revision, let's just guess the Firefox version from the date.
$browserver = $match[1];
if ($browserver > 20000000) {
// This is just a guess, it is not supposed to be 100% accurate!
if (preg_match('/^201/', $browserver)) {
$browserver = 3.6;
} else if (preg_match('/^200[7-9]/', $browserver)) {
$browserver = 3;
} else if (preg_match('/^2006/', $version)) {
$browserver = 2;
} else {
$browserver = 1.5;
}
}
if (version_compare($browserver, $version) >= 0) {
return true;
}
}
break;
case 'MSIE': /// Internet Explorer
if (strpos($agent, 'Opera') !== false) { // Reject Opera
return false;
}
// In case of IE we have to deal with BC of the version parameter.
if (is_null($version)) {
$version = 5.5; // Anything older is not considered a browser at all!
}
// IE uses simple versions, let's cast it to float to simplify the logic here.
$version = round($version, 1);
// See: http://www.useragentstring.com/pages/Internet%20Explorer/
if (preg_match("/MSIE ([0-9\.]+)/", $agent, $match)) {
$browser = $match[1];
} else {
return false;
}
// IE8 and later versions may pretend to be IE7 for intranet sites, use Trident version instead,
// the Trident should always describe the capabilities of IE in any emulation mode.
if ($browser === '7.0' and preg_match("/Trident\/([0-9\.]+)/", $agent, $match)) {
$browser = $match[1] + 4; // NOTE: Hopefully this will work also for future IE versions.
}
$browser = round($browser, 1);
return ($browser >= $version);
break;
case 'Opera': /// Opera
if (strpos($agent, 'Opera') === false) {
return false;
}
if (empty($version)) {
return true; // no version specified
}
// Recent Opera useragents have Version/ with the actual version, e.g.:
// Opera/9.80 (Windows NT 6.1; WOW64; U; en) Presto/2.10.289 Version/12.01
// That's Opera 12.01, not 9.8.
if (preg_match("/Version\/([0-9\.]+)/i", $agent, $match)) {
if (version_compare($match[1], $version) >= 0) {
return true;
}
} else if (preg_match("/Opera\/([0-9\.]+)/i", $agent, $match)) {
if (version_compare($match[1], $version) >= 0) {
return true;
}
}
break;
case 'WebKit': /// WebKit based browser - everything derived from it (Safari, Chrome, iOS, Android and other mobiles)
if (strpos($agent, 'AppleWebKit') === false) {
return false;
}
if (empty($version)) {
return true; // no version specified
}
if (preg_match("/AppleWebKit\/([0-9.]+)/i", $agent, $match)) {
if (version_compare($match[1], $version) >= 0) {
return true;
}
}
break;
case 'Safari': /// Desktop version of Apple Safari browser - no mobile or touch devices
if (strpos($agent, 'AppleWebKit') === false) {
return false;
}
// Look for AppleWebKit, excluding strings with OmniWeb, Shiira and SymbianOS and any other mobile devices
if (strpos($agent, 'OmniWeb')) { // Reject OmniWeb
return false;
}
if (strpos($agent, 'Shiira')) { // Reject Shiira
return false;
}
if (strpos($agent, 'SymbianOS')) { // Reject SymbianOS
return false;
}
if (strpos($agent, 'Android')) { // Reject Androids too
return false;
}
if (strpos($agent, 'iPhone') or strpos($agent, 'iPad') or strpos($agent, 'iPod')) {
// No Apple mobile devices here - editor does not work, course ajax is not touch compatible, etc.
return false;
}
if (strpos($agent, 'Chrome')) { // Reject chrome browsers - it needs to be tested explicitly
return false;
}
if (empty($version)) {
return true; // no version specified
}
if (preg_match("/AppleWebKit\/([0-9.]+)/i", $agent, $match)) {
if (version_compare($match[1], $version) >= 0) {
return true;
}
}
break;
case 'Chrome':
if (strpos($agent, 'Chrome') === false) {
return false;
}
if (empty($version)) {
return true; // no version specified
}
if (preg_match("/Chrome\/(.*)[ ]+/i", $agent, $match)) {
if (version_compare($match[1], $version) >= 0) {
return true;
}
}
break;
case 'Safari iOS': /// Safari on iPhone, iPad and iPod touch
if (strpos($agent, 'AppleWebKit') === false or strpos($agent, 'Safari') === false) {
return false;
}
if (!strpos($agent, 'iPhone') and !strpos($agent, 'iPad') and !strpos($agent, 'iPod')) {
return false;
}
if (empty($version)) {
return true; // no version specified
}
if (preg_match("/AppleWebKit\/([0-9]+)/i", $agent, $match)) {
if (version_compare($match[1], $version) >= 0) {
return true;
}
}
break;
case 'WebKit Android': /// WebKit browser on Android
if (strpos($agent, 'Linux; U; Android') === false) {
return false;
}
if (empty($version)) {
return true; // no version specified
}
if (preg_match("/AppleWebKit\/([0-9]+)/i", $agent, $match)) {
if (version_compare($match[1], $version) >= 0) {
return true;
}
}
break;
}
return false;
}
/**
* Returns whether a device/browser combination is mobile, tablet, legacy, default or the result of
* an optional admin specified regular expression. If enabledevicedetection is set to no or not set
* it returns default
*
* @return string device type
*/
function get_device_type() {
global $CFG;
if (empty($CFG->enabledevicedetection) || empty($_SERVER['HTTP_USER_AGENT'])) {
return 'default';
}
$useragent = $_SERVER['HTTP_USER_AGENT'];
if (!empty($CFG->devicedetectregex)) {
$regexes = json_decode($CFG->devicedetectregex);
foreach ($regexes as $value=>$regex) {
if (preg_match($regex, $useragent)) {
return $value;
}
}
}
//mobile detection PHP direct copy from open source detectmobilebrowser.com
$phonesregex = '/android .+ mobile|avantgo|blackberry|blazer|compal|elaine|fennec|hiptop|iemobile|ip(hone|od)|iris|kindle|lge |maemo|midp|mmp|opera m(ob|in)i|palm( os)?|phone|p(ixi|re)\/|plucker|pocket|psp|symbian|treo|up\.(browser|link)|vodafone|wap|windows (ce|phone)|xda|xiino/i';
$modelsregex = '/1207|6310|6590|3gso|4thp|50[1-6]i|770s|802s|a wa|abac|ac(er|oo|s\-)|ai(ko|rn)|al(av|ca|co)|amoi|an(ex|ny|yw)|aptu|ar(ch|go)|as(te|us)|attw|au(di|\-m|r |s )|avan|be(ck|ll|nq)|bi(lb|rd)|bl(ac|az)|br(e|v)w|bumb|bw\-(n|u)|c55\/|capi|ccwa|cdm\-|cell|chtm|cldc|cmd\-|co(mp|nd)|craw|da(it|ll|ng)|dbte|dc\-s|devi|dica|dmob|do(c|p)o|ds(12|\-d)|el(49|ai)|em(l2|ul)|er(ic|k0)|esl8|ez([4-7]0|os|wa|ze)|fetc|fly(\-|_)|g1 u|g560|gene|gf\-5|g\-mo|go(\.w|od)|gr(ad|un)|haie|hcit|hd\-(m|p|t)|hei\-|hi(pt|ta)|hp( i|ip)|hs\-c|ht(c(\-| |_|a|g|p|s|t)|tp)|hu(aw|tc)|i\-(20|go|ma)|i230|iac( |\-|\/)|ibro|idea|ig01|ikom|im1k|inno|ipaq|iris|ja(t|v)a|jbro|jemu|jigs|kddi|keji|kgt( |\/)|klon|kpt |kwc\-|kyo(c|k)|le(no|xi)|lg( g|\/(k|l|u)|50|54|e\-|e\/|\-[a-w])|libw|lynx|m1\-w|m3ga|m50\/|ma(te|ui|xo)|mc(01|21|ca)|m\-cr|me(di|rc|ri)|mi(o8|oa|ts)|mmef|mo(01|02|bi|de|do|t(\-| |o|v)|zz)|mt(50|p1|v )|mwbp|mywa|n10[0-2]|n20[2-3]|n30(0|2)|n50(0|2|5)|n7(0(0|1)|10)|ne((c|m)\-|on|tf|wf|wg|wt)|nok(6|i)|nzph|o2im|op(ti|wv)|oran|owg1|p800|pan(a|d|t)|pdxg|pg(13|\-([1-8]|c))|phil|pire|pl(ay|uc)|pn\-2|po(ck|rt|se)|prox|psio|pt\-g|qa\-a|qc(07|12|21|32|60|\-[2-7]|i\-)|qtek|r380|r600|raks|rim9|ro(ve|zo)|s55\/|sa(ge|ma|mm|ms|ny|va)|sc(01|h\-|oo|p\-)|sdk\/|se(c(\-|0|1)|47|mc|nd|ri)|sgh\-|shar|sie(\-|m)|sk\-0|sl(45|id)|sm(al|ar|b3|it|t5)|so(ft|ny)|sp(01|h\-|v\-|v )|sy(01|mb)|t2(18|50)|t6(00|10|18)|ta(gt|lk)|tcl\-|tdg\-|tel(i|m)|tim\-|t\-mo|to(pl|sh)|ts(70|m\-|m3|m5)|tx\-9|up(\.b|g1|si)|utst|v400|v750|veri|vi(rg|te)|vk(40|5[0-3]|\-v)|vm40|voda|vulc|vx(52|53|60|61|70|80|81|83|85|98)|w3c(\-| )|webc|whit|wi(g |nc|nw)|wmlb|wonu|x700|xda(\-|2|g)|yas\-|your|zeto|zte\-/i';
if (preg_match($phonesregex,$useragent) || preg_match($modelsregex,substr($useragent, 0, 4))){
return 'mobile';
}
$tabletregex = '/Tablet browser|android|iPad|iProd|GT-P1000|GT-I9000|SHW-M180S|SGH-T849|SCH-I800|Build\/ERE27|sholest/i';
if (preg_match($tabletregex, $useragent)) {
return 'tablet';
}
// Safe way to check for IE6 and not get false positives for some IE 7/8 users
if (substr($_SERVER['HTTP_USER_AGENT'], 0, 34) === 'Mozilla/4.0 (compatible; MSIE 6.0;') {
return 'legacy';
}
return 'default';
}
/**
* Returns a list of the device types supporting by Moodle
*
* @param boolean $incusertypes includes types specified using the devicedetectregex admin setting
* @return array $types
*/
function get_device_type_list($incusertypes = true) {
global $CFG;
$types = array('default', 'legacy', 'mobile', 'tablet');
if ($incusertypes && !empty($CFG->devicedetectregex)) {
$regexes = json_decode($CFG->devicedetectregex);
foreach ($regexes as $value => $regex) {
$types[] = $value;
}
}
return $types;
}
/**
* Returns the theme selected for a particular device or false if none selected.
*
* @param string $devicetype
* @return string|false The name of the theme to use for the device or the false if not set
*/
function get_selected_theme_for_device_type($devicetype = null) {
global $CFG;
if (empty($devicetype)) {
$devicetype = get_user_device_type();
}
$themevarname = get_device_cfg_var_name($devicetype);
if (empty($CFG->$themevarname)) {
return false;
}
return $CFG->$themevarname;
}
/**
* Returns the name of the device type theme var in $CFG (because there is not a standard convention to allow backwards compatability
*
* @param string $devicetype
* @return string The config variable to use to determine the theme
*/
function get_device_cfg_var_name($devicetype = null) {
if ($devicetype == 'default' || empty($devicetype)) {
return 'theme';
}
return 'theme' . $devicetype;
}
/**
* Allows the user to switch the device they are seeing the theme for.
* This allows mobile users to switch back to the default theme, or theme for any other device.
*
* @param string $newdevice The device the user is currently using.
* @return string The device the user has switched to
*/
function set_user_device_type($newdevice) {
global $USER;
$devicetype = get_device_type();
$devicetypes = get_device_type_list();
if ($newdevice == $devicetype) {
unset_user_preference('switchdevice'.$devicetype);
} else if (in_array($newdevice, $devicetypes)) {
set_user_preference('switchdevice'.$devicetype, $newdevice);
}
}
/**
* Returns the device the user is currently using, or if the user has chosen to switch devices
* for the current device type the type they have switched to.
*
* @return string The device the user is currently using or wishes to use
*/
function get_user_device_type() {
$device = get_device_type();
$switched = get_user_preferences('switchdevice'.$device, false);
if ($switched != false) {
return $switched;
}
return $device;
}
/**
* Returns one or several CSS class names that match the user's browser. These can be put
* in the body tag of the page to apply browser-specific rules without relying on CSS hacks
*
* @return array An array of browser version classes
*/
function get_browser_version_classes() {
$classes = array();
if (check_browser_version("MSIE", "0")) {
$classes[] = 'ie';
for($i=12; $i>=6; $i--) {
if (check_browser_version("MSIE", $i)) {
$classes[] = 'ie'.$i;
break;
}
}
} else if (check_browser_version("Firefox") || check_browser_version("Gecko") || check_browser_version("Camino")) {
$classes[] = 'gecko';
if (preg_match('/rv\:([1-2])\.([0-9])/', $_SERVER['HTTP_USER_AGENT'], $matches)) {
$classes[] = "gecko{$matches[1]}{$matches[2]}";
}
} else if (check_browser_version("WebKit")) {
$classes[] = 'safari';
if (check_browser_version("Safari iOS")) {
$classes[] = 'ios';
} else if (check_browser_version("WebKit Android")) {
$classes[] = 'android';
}
} else if (check_browser_version("Opera")) {
$classes[] = 'opera';
}
return $classes;
}
/**
* Can handle rotated text. Whether it is safe to use the trickery in textrotate.js.
*
* @return bool True for yes, false for no
*/
function can_use_rotated_text() {
return check_browser_version('MSIE', 9) || check_browser_version('Firefox', 2) ||
check_browser_version('Chrome', 21) || check_browser_version('Safari', 536.25) ||
check_browser_version('Opera', 12) || check_browser_version('Safari iOS', 533);
}
/**
* Determine if moodle installation requires update
*
* Checks version numbers of main code and all modules to see
* if there are any mismatches
*
* @global moodle_database $DB
* @return bool
*/
function moodle_needs_upgrading() {
global $CFG, $DB, $OUTPUT;
if (empty($CFG->version)) {
return true;
}
// We have to purge plugin related caches now to be sure we have fresh data
// and new plugins can be detected.
cache::make('core', 'plugintypes')->purge();
cache::make('core', 'pluginlist')->purge();
cache::make('core', 'plugininfo_base')->purge();
cache::make('core', 'plugininfo_mod')->purge();
cache::make('core', 'plugininfo_block')->purge();
cache::make('core', 'plugininfo_filter')->purge();
cache::make('core', 'plugininfo_repository')->purge();
cache::make('core', 'plugininfo_portfolio')->purge();
// Check the main version first.
$version = null;
include($CFG->dirroot.'/version.php'); // defines $version and upgrades
if ($version > $CFG->version) {
return true;
}
// modules
$mods = get_plugin_list('mod');
$installed = $DB->get_records('modules', array(), '', 'name, version');
foreach ($mods as $mod => $fullmod) {
if ($mod === 'NEWMODULE') { // Someone has unzipped the template, ignore it
continue;
}
$module = new stdClass();
$plugin = new stdClass();
if (!is_readable($fullmod.'/version.php')) {
continue;
}
include($fullmod.'/version.php'); // defines $module with version etc
if (!isset($module->version) and isset($plugin->version)) {
$module = $plugin;
}
if (empty($installed[$mod])) {
return true;
} else if ($module->version > $installed[$mod]->version) {
return true;
}
}
unset($installed);
// blocks
$blocks = get_plugin_list('block');
$installed = $DB->get_records('block', array(), '', 'name, version');
require_once($CFG->dirroot.'/blocks/moodleblock.class.php');
foreach ($blocks as $blockname=>$fullblock) {
if ($blockname === 'NEWBLOCK') { // Someone has unzipped the template, ignore it
continue;
}
if (!is_readable($fullblock.'/version.php')) {
continue;
}
$plugin = new stdClass();
$plugin->version = NULL;
include($fullblock.'/version.php');
if (empty($installed[$blockname])) {
return true;
} else if ($plugin->version > $installed[$blockname]->version) {
return true;
}
}
unset($installed);
// now the rest of plugins
$plugintypes = get_plugin_types();
unset($plugintypes['mod']);
unset($plugintypes['block']);
$versions = $DB->get_records_menu('config_plugins', array('name' => 'version'), 'plugin', 'plugin, value');
foreach ($plugintypes as $type=>$unused) {
$plugs = get_plugin_list($type);
foreach ($plugs as $plug=>$fullplug) {
$component = $type.'_'.$plug;
if (!is_readable($fullplug.'/version.php')) {
continue;
}
$plugin = new stdClass();
include($fullplug.'/version.php'); // defines $plugin with version etc
if (array_key_exists($component, $versions)) {
$installedversion = $versions[$component];
} else {
$installedversion = get_config($component, 'version');
}
if (empty($installedversion)) { // new installation
return true;
} else if ($installedversion < $plugin->version) { // upgrade
return true;
}
}
}
return false;
}
/**
* Returns the major version of this site
*
* Moodle version numbers consist of three numbers separated by a dot, for
* example 1.9.11 or 2.0.2. The first two numbers, like 1.9 or 2.0, represent so
* called major version. This function extracts the major version from either
* $CFG->release (default) or eventually from the $release variable defined in
* the main version.php.
*
* @param bool $fromdisk should the version if source code files be used
* @return string|false the major version like '2.3', false if could not be determined
*/
function moodle_major_version($fromdisk = false) {
global $CFG;
if ($fromdisk) {
$release = null;
require($CFG->dirroot.'/version.php');
if (empty($release)) {
return false;
}
} else {
if (empty($CFG->release)) {
return false;
}
$release = $CFG->release;
}
if (preg_match('/^[0-9]+\.[0-9]+/', $release, $matches)) {
return $matches[0];
} else {
return false;
}
}
/// MISCELLANEOUS ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
/**
* Sets the system locale
*
* @category string
* @param string $locale Can be used to force a locale
*/
function moodle_setlocale($locale='') {
global $CFG;
static $currentlocale = ''; // last locale caching
$oldlocale = $currentlocale;
/// Fetch the correct locale based on ostype
if ($CFG->ostype == 'WINDOWS') {
$stringtofetch = 'localewin';
} else {
$stringtofetch = 'locale';
}
/// the priority is the same as in get_string() - parameter, config, course, session, user, global language
if (!empty($locale)) {
$currentlocale = $locale;
} else if (!empty($CFG->locale)) { // override locale for all language packs
$currentlocale = $CFG->locale;
} else {
$currentlocale = get_string($stringtofetch, 'langconfig');
}
/// do nothing if locale already set up
if ($oldlocale == $currentlocale) {
return;
}
/// Due to some strange BUG we cannot set the LC_TIME directly, so we fetch current values,
/// set LC_ALL and then set values again. Just wondering why we cannot set LC_ALL only??? - stronk7
/// Some day, numeric, monetary and other categories should be set too, I think. :-/
/// Get current values
$monetary= setlocale (LC_MONETARY, 0);
$numeric = setlocale (LC_NUMERIC, 0);
$ctype = setlocale (LC_CTYPE, 0);
if ($CFG->ostype != 'WINDOWS') {
$messages= setlocale (LC_MESSAGES, 0);
}
/// Set locale to all
setlocale (LC_ALL, $currentlocale);
/// Set old values
setlocale (LC_MONETARY, $monetary);
setlocale (LC_NUMERIC, $numeric);
if ($CFG->ostype != 'WINDOWS') {
setlocale (LC_MESSAGES, $messages);
}
if ($currentlocale == 'tr_TR' or $currentlocale == 'tr_TR.UTF-8') { // To workaround a well-known PHP problem with Turkish letter Ii
setlocale (LC_CTYPE, $ctype);
}
}
/**
* Count words in a string.
*
* Words are defined as things between whitespace.
*
* @category string
* @param string $string The text to be searched for words.
* @return int The count of words in the specified string
*/
function count_words($string) {
$string = strip_tags($string);
return count(preg_split("/\w\b/", $string)) - 1;
}
/** Count letters in a string.
*
* Letters are defined as chars not in tags and different from whitespace.
*
* @category string
* @param string $string The text to be searched for letters.
* @return int The count of letters in the specified text.
*/
function count_letters($string) {
/// Loading the textlib singleton instance. We are going to need it.
$string = strip_tags($string); // Tags are out now
$string = preg_replace('/[[:space:]]*/','',$string); //Whitespace are out now
return textlib::strlen($string);
}
/**
* Generate and return a random string of the specified length.
*
* @param int $length The length of the string to be created.
* @return string
*/
function random_string ($length=15) {
$pool = 'ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ';
$pool .= 'abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz';
$pool .= '0123456789';
$poollen = strlen($pool);
mt_srand ((double) microtime() * 1000000);
$string = '';
for ($i = 0; $i < $length; $i++) {
$string .= substr($pool, (mt_rand()%($poollen)), 1);
}
return $string;
}
/**
* Generate a complex random string (useful for md5 salts)
*
* This function is based on the above {@link random_string()} however it uses a
* larger pool of characters and generates a string between 24 and 32 characters
*
* @param int $length Optional if set generates a string to exactly this length
* @return string
*/
function complex_random_string($length=null) {
$pool = 'ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZabcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz0123456789';
$pool .= '`~!@#%^&*()_+-=[];,./<>?:{} ';
$poollen = strlen($pool);
mt_srand ((double) microtime() * 1000000);
if ($length===null) {
$length = floor(rand(24,32));
}
$string = '';
for ($i = 0; $i < $length; $i++) {
$string .= $pool[(mt_rand()%$poollen)];
}
return $string;
}
/**
* Given some text (which may contain HTML) and an ideal length,
* this function truncates the text neatly on a word boundary if possible
*
* @category string
* @global stdClass $CFG
* @param string $text text to be shortened
* @param int $ideal ideal string length
* @param boolean $exact if false, $text will not be cut mid-word
* @param string $ending The string to append if the passed string is truncated
* @return string $truncate shortened string
*/
function shorten_text($text, $ideal=30, $exact = false, $ending='...') {
global $CFG;
// if the plain text is shorter than the maximum length, return the whole text
if (textlib::strlen(preg_replace('/<.*?>/', '', $text)) <= $ideal) {
return $text;
}
// Splits on HTML tags. Each open/close/empty tag will be the first thing
// and only tag in its 'line'
preg_match_all('/(<.+?>)?([^<>]*)/s', $text, $lines, PREG_SET_ORDER);
$total_length = textlib::strlen($ending);
$truncate = '';
// This array stores information about open and close tags and their position
// in the truncated string. Each item in the array is an object with fields
// ->open (true if open), ->tag (tag name in lower case), and ->pos
// (byte position in truncated text)
$tagdetails = array();
foreach ($lines as $line_matchings) {
// if there is any html-tag in this line, handle it and add it (uncounted) to the output
if (!empty($line_matchings[1])) {
// if it's an "empty element" with or without xhtml-conform closing slash (f.e. <br/>)
if (preg_match('/^<(\s*.+?\/\s*|\s*(img|br|input|hr|area|base|basefont|col|frame|isindex|link|meta|param)(\s.+?)?)>$/is', $line_matchings[1])) {
// do nothing
// if tag is a closing tag (f.e. </b>)
} else if (preg_match('/^<\s*\/([^\s]+?)\s*>$/s', $line_matchings[1], $tag_matchings)) {
// record closing tag
$tagdetails[] = (object)array('open'=>false,
'tag'=>textlib::strtolower($tag_matchings[1]), 'pos'=>textlib::strlen($truncate));
// if tag is an opening tag (f.e. <b>)
} else if (preg_match('/^<\s*([^\s>!]+).*?>$/s', $line_matchings[1], $tag_matchings)) {
// record opening tag
$tagdetails[] = (object)array('open'=>true,
'tag'=>textlib::strtolower($tag_matchings[1]), 'pos'=>textlib::strlen($truncate));
}
// add html-tag to $truncate'd text
$truncate .= $line_matchings[1];
}
// calculate the length of the plain text part of the line; handle entities as one character
$content_length = textlib::strlen(preg_replace('/&[0-9a-z]{2,8};|&#[0-9]{1,7};|&#x[0-9a-f]{1,6};/i', ' ', $line_matchings[2]));
if ($total_length+$content_length > $ideal) {
// the number of characters which are left
$left = $ideal - $total_length;
$entities_length = 0;
// search for html entities
if (preg_match_all('/&[0-9a-z]{2,8};|&#[0-9]{1,7};|&#x[0-9a-f]{1,6};/i', $line_matchings[2], $entities, PREG_OFFSET_CAPTURE)) {
// calculate the real length of all entities in the legal range
foreach ($entities[0] as $entity) {
if ($entity[1]+1-$entities_length <= $left) {
$left--;
$entities_length += textlib::strlen($entity[0]);
} else {
// no more characters left
break;
}
}
}
$truncate .= textlib::substr($line_matchings[2], 0, $left+$entities_length);
// maximum length is reached, so get off the loop
break;
} else {
$truncate .= $line_matchings[2];
$total_length += $content_length;
}
// if the maximum length is reached, get off the loop
if($total_length >= $ideal) {
break;
}
}
// if the words shouldn't be cut in the middle...
if (!$exact) {
// ...search the last occurence of a space...
for ($k=textlib::strlen($truncate);$k>0;$k--) {
if ($char = textlib::substr($truncate, $k, 1)) {
if ($char === '.' or $char === ' ') {
$breakpos = $k+1;
break;
} else if (strlen($char) > 2) { // Chinese/Japanese/Korean text
$breakpos = $k+1; // can be truncated at any UTF-8
break; // character boundary.
}
}
}
if (isset($breakpos)) {
// ...and cut the text in this position
$truncate = textlib::substr($truncate, 0, $breakpos);
}
}
// add the defined ending to the text
$truncate .= $ending;
// Now calculate the list of open html tags based on the truncate position
$open_tags = array();
foreach ($tagdetails as $taginfo) {
if(isset($breakpos) && $taginfo->pos >= $breakpos) {
// Don't include tags after we made the break!
break;
}
if($taginfo->open) {
// add tag to the beginning of $open_tags list
array_unshift($open_tags, $taginfo->tag);
} else {
$pos = array_search($taginfo->tag, array_reverse($open_tags, true)); // can have multiple exact same open tags, close the last one
if ($pos !== false) {
unset($open_tags[$pos]);
}
}
}
// close all unclosed html-tags
foreach ($open_tags as $tag) {
$truncate .= '</' . $tag . '>';
}
return $truncate;
}
/**
* Given dates in seconds, how many weeks is the date from startdate
* The first week is 1, the second 2 etc ...
*
* @todo Finish documenting this function
*
* @uses WEEKSECS
* @param int $startdate Timestamp for the start date
* @param int $thedate Timestamp for the end date
* @return string
*/
function getweek ($startdate, $thedate) {
if ($thedate < $startdate) { // error
return 0;
}
return floor(($thedate - $startdate) / WEEKSECS) + 1;
}
/**
* returns a randomly generated password of length $maxlen. inspired by
*
* {@link http://www.phpbuilder.com/columns/jesus19990502.php3} and
* {@link http://es2.php.net/manual/en/function.str-shuffle.php#73254}
*
* @global stdClass $CFG
* @param int $maxlen The maximum size of the password being generated.
* @return string
*/
function generate_password($maxlen=10) {
global $CFG;
if (empty($CFG->passwordpolicy)) {
$fillers = PASSWORD_DIGITS;
$wordlist = file($CFG->wordlist);
$word1 = trim($wordlist[rand(0, count($wordlist) - 1)]);
$word2 = trim($wordlist[rand(0, count($wordlist) - 1)]);
$filler1 = $fillers[rand(0, strlen($fillers) - 1)];
$password = $word1 . $filler1 . $word2;
} else {
$minlen = !empty($CFG->minpasswordlength) ? $CFG->minpasswordlength : 0;
$digits = $CFG->minpassworddigits;
$lower = $CFG->minpasswordlower;
$upper = $CFG->minpasswordupper;
$nonalphanum = $CFG->minpasswordnonalphanum;
$total = $lower + $upper + $digits + $nonalphanum;
// minlength should be the greater one of the two ( $minlen and $total )
$minlen = $minlen < $total ? $total : $minlen;
// maxlen can never be smaller than minlen
$maxlen = $minlen > $maxlen ? $minlen : $maxlen;
$additional = $maxlen - $total;
// Make sure we have enough characters to fulfill
// complexity requirements
$passworddigits = PASSWORD_DIGITS;
while ($digits > strlen($passworddigits)) {
$passworddigits .= PASSWORD_DIGITS;
}
$passwordlower = PASSWORD_LOWER;
while ($lower > strlen($passwordlower)) {
$passwordlower .= PASSWORD_LOWER;
}
$passwordupper = PASSWORD_UPPER;
while ($upper > strlen($passwordupper)) {
$passwordupper .= PASSWORD_UPPER;
}
$passwordnonalphanum = PASSWORD_NONALPHANUM;
while ($nonalphanum > strlen($passwordnonalphanum)) {
$passwordnonalphanum .= PASSWORD_NONALPHANUM;
}
// Now mix and shuffle it all
$password = str_shuffle (substr(str_shuffle ($passwordlower), 0, $lower) .
substr(str_shuffle ($passwordupper), 0, $upper) .
substr(str_shuffle ($passworddigits), 0, $digits) .
substr(str_shuffle ($passwordnonalphanum), 0 , $nonalphanum) .
substr(str_shuffle ($passwordlower .
$passwordupper .
$passworddigits .
$passwordnonalphanum), 0 , $additional));
}
return substr ($password, 0, $maxlen);
}
/**
* Given a float, prints it nicely.
* Localized floats must not be used in calculations!
*
* The stripzeros feature is intended for making numbers look nicer in small
* areas where it is not necessary to indicate the degree of accuracy by showing
* ending zeros. If you turn it on with $decimalpoints set to 3, for example,
* then it will display '5.4' instead of '5.400' or '5' instead of '5.000'.
*
* @param float $float The float to print
* @param int $decimalpoints The number of decimal places to print.
* @param bool $localized use localized decimal separator
* @param bool $stripzeros If true, removes final zeros after decimal point
* @return string locale float
*/
function format_float($float, $decimalpoints=1, $localized=true, $stripzeros=false) {
if (is_null($float)) {
return '';
}
if ($localized) {
$separator = get_string('decsep', 'langconfig');
} else {
$separator = '.';
}
$result = number_format($float, $decimalpoints, $separator, '');
if ($stripzeros) {
// Remove zeros and final dot if not needed
$result = preg_replace('~(' . preg_quote($separator) . ')?0+$~', '', $result);
}
return $result;
}
/**
* Converts locale specific floating point/comma number back to standard PHP float value
* Do NOT try to do any math operations before this conversion on any user submitted floats!
*
* @param string $locale_float locale aware float representation
* @return float
*/
function unformat_float($locale_float) {
$locale_float = trim($locale_float);
if ($locale_float == '') {
return null;
}
$locale_float = str_replace(' ', '', $locale_float); // no spaces - those might be used as thousand separators
return (float)str_replace(get_string('decsep', 'langconfig'), '.', $locale_float);
}
/**
* Given a simple array, this shuffles it up just like shuffle()
* Unlike PHP's shuffle() this function works on any machine.
*
* @param array $array The array to be rearranged
* @return array
*/
function swapshuffle($array) {
srand ((double) microtime() * 10000000);
$last = count($array) - 1;
for ($i=0;$i<=$last;$i++) {
$from = rand(0,$last);
$curr = $array[$i];
$array[$i] = $array[$from];
$array[$from] = $curr;
}
return $array;
}
/**
* Like {@link swapshuffle()}, but works on associative arrays
*
* @param array $array The associative array to be rearranged
* @return array
*/
function swapshuffle_assoc($array) {
$newarray = array();
$newkeys = swapshuffle(array_keys($array));
foreach ($newkeys as $newkey) {
$newarray[$newkey] = $array[$newkey];
}
return $newarray;
}
/**
* Given an arbitrary array, and a number of draws,
* this function returns an array with that amount
* of items. The indexes are retained.
*
* @todo Finish documenting this function
*
* @param array $array
* @param int $draws
* @return array
*/
function draw_rand_array($array, $draws) {
srand ((double) microtime() * 10000000);
$return = array();
$last = count($array);
if ($draws > $last) {
$draws = $last;
}
while ($draws > 0) {
$last--;
$keys = array_keys($array);
$rand = rand(0, $last);
$return[$keys[$rand]] = $array[$keys[$rand]];
unset($array[$keys[$rand]]);
$draws--;
}
return $return;
}
/**
* Calculate the difference between two microtimes
*
* @param string $a The first Microtime
* @param string $b The second Microtime
* @return string
*/
function microtime_diff($a, $b) {
list($a_dec, $a_sec) = explode(' ', $a);
list($b_dec, $b_sec) = explode(' ', $b);
return $b_sec - $a_sec + $b_dec - $a_dec;
}
/**
* Given a list (eg a,b,c,d,e) this function returns
* an array of 1->a, 2->b, 3->c etc
*
* @param string $list The string to explode into array bits
* @param string $separator The separator used within the list string
* @return array The now assembled array
*/
function make_menu_from_list($list, $separator=',') {
$array = array_reverse(explode($separator, $list), true);
foreach ($array as $key => $item) {
$outarray[$key+1] = trim($item);
}
return $outarray;
}
/**
* Creates an array that represents all the current grades that
* can be chosen using the given grading type.
*
* Negative numbers
* are scales, zero is no grade, and positive numbers are maximum
* grades.
*
* @todo Finish documenting this function or better deprecated this completely!
*
* @param int $gradingtype
* @return array
*/
function make_grades_menu($gradingtype) {
global $DB;
$grades = array();
if ($gradingtype < 0) {
if ($scale = $DB->get_record('scale', array('id'=> (-$gradingtype)))) {
return make_menu_from_list($scale->scale);
}
} else if ($gradingtype > 0) {
for ($i=$gradingtype; $i>=0; $i--) {
$grades[$i] = $i .' / '. $gradingtype;
}
return $grades;
}
return $grades;
}
/**
* This function returns the number of activities
* using scaleid in a courseid
*
* @todo Finish documenting this function
*
* @global object
* @global object
* @param int $courseid ?
* @param int $scaleid ?
* @return int
*/
function course_scale_used($courseid, $scaleid) {
global $CFG, $DB;
$return = 0;
if (!empty($scaleid)) {
if ($cms = get_course_mods($courseid)) {
foreach ($cms as $cm) {
//Check cm->name/lib.php exists
if (file_exists($CFG->dirroot.'/mod/'.$cm->modname.'/lib.php')) {
include_once($CFG->dirroot.'/mod/'.$cm->modname.'/lib.php');
$function_name = $cm->modname.'_scale_used';
if (function_exists($function_name)) {
if ($function_name($cm->instance,$scaleid)) {
$return++;
}
}
}
}
}
// check if any course grade item makes use of the scale
$return += $DB->count_records('grade_items', array('courseid'=>$courseid, 'scaleid'=>$scaleid));
// check if any outcome in the course makes use of the scale
$return += $DB->count_records_sql("SELECT COUNT('x')
FROM {grade_outcomes_courses} goc,
{grade_outcomes} go
WHERE go.id = goc.outcomeid
AND go.scaleid = ? AND goc.courseid = ?",
array($scaleid, $courseid));
}
return $return;
}
/**
* This function returns the number of activities
* using scaleid in the entire site
*
* @param int $scaleid
* @param array $courses
* @return int
*/
function site_scale_used($scaleid, &$courses) {
$return = 0;
if (!is_array($courses) || count($courses) == 0) {
$courses = get_courses("all",false,"c.id,c.shortname");
}
if (!empty($scaleid)) {
if (is_array($courses) && count($courses) > 0) {
foreach ($courses as $course) {
$return += course_scale_used($course->id,$scaleid);
}
}
}
return $return;
}
/**
* make_unique_id_code
*
* @todo Finish documenting this function
*
* @uses $_SERVER
* @param string $extra Extra string to append to the end of the code
* @return string
*/
function make_unique_id_code($extra='') {
$hostname = 'unknownhost';
if (!empty($_SERVER['HTTP_HOST'])) {
$hostname = $_SERVER['HTTP_HOST'];
} else if (!empty($_ENV['HTTP_HOST'])) {
$hostname = $_ENV['HTTP_HOST'];
} else if (!empty($_SERVER['SERVER_NAME'])) {
$hostname = $_SERVER['SERVER_NAME'];
} else if (!empty($_ENV['SERVER_NAME'])) {
$hostname = $_ENV['SERVER_NAME'];
}
$date = gmdate("ymdHis");
$random = random_string(6);
if ($extra) {
return $hostname .'+'. $date .'+'. $random .'+'. $extra;
} else {
return $hostname .'+'. $date .'+'. $random;
}
}
/**
* Function to check the passed address is within the passed subnet
*
* The parameter is a comma separated string of subnet definitions.
* Subnet strings can be in one of three formats:
* 1: xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/nn or xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx/nnn (number of bits in net mask)
* 2: xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx-yyy or xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx::xxxx-yyyy (a range of IP addresses in the last group)
* 3: xxx.xxx or xxx.xxx. or xxx:xxx:xxxx or xxx:xxx:xxxx. (incomplete address, a bit non-technical ;-)
* Code for type 1 modified from user posted comments by mediator at
* {@link http://au.php.net/manual/en/function.ip2long.php}
*
* @param string $addr The address you are checking
* @param string $subnetstr The string of subnet addresses
* @return bool
*/
function address_in_subnet($addr, $subnetstr) {
if ($addr == '0.0.0.0') {
return false;
}
$subnets = explode(',', $subnetstr);
$found = false;
$addr = trim($addr);
$addr = cleanremoteaddr($addr, false); // normalise
if ($addr === null) {
return false;
}
$addrparts = explode(':', $addr);
$ipv6 = strpos($addr, ':');
foreach ($subnets as $subnet) {
$subnet = trim($subnet);
if ($subnet === '') {
continue;
}
if (strpos($subnet, '/') !== false) {
///1: xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/nn or xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx/nnn
list($ip, $mask) = explode('/', $subnet);
$mask = trim($mask);
if (!is_number($mask)) {
continue; // incorect mask number, eh?
}
$ip = cleanremoteaddr($ip, false); // normalise
if ($ip === null) {
continue;
}
if (strpos($ip, ':') !== false) {
// IPv6
if (!$ipv6) {
continue;
}
if ($mask > 128 or $mask < 0) {
continue; // nonsense
}
if ($mask == 0) {
return true; // any address
}
if ($mask == 128) {
if ($ip === $addr) {
return true;
}
continue;
}
$ipparts = explode(':', $ip);
$modulo = $mask % 16;
$ipnet = array_slice($ipparts, 0, ($mask-$modulo)/16);
$addrnet = array_slice($addrparts, 0, ($mask-$modulo)/16);
if (implode(':', $ipnet) === implode(':', $addrnet)) {
if ($modulo == 0) {
return true;
}
$pos = ($mask-$modulo)/16;
$ipnet = hexdec($ipparts[$pos]);
$addrnet = hexdec($addrparts[$pos]);
$mask = 0xffff << (16 - $modulo);
if (($addrnet & $mask) == ($ipnet & $mask)) {
return true;
}
}
} else {
// IPv4
if ($ipv6) {
continue;
}
if ($mask > 32 or $mask < 0) {
continue; // nonsense
}
if ($mask == 0) {
return true;
}
if ($mask == 32) {
if ($ip === $addr) {
return true;
}
continue;
}
$mask = 0xffffffff << (32 - $mask);
if (((ip2long($addr) & $mask) == (ip2long($ip) & $mask))) {
return true;
}
}
} else if (strpos($subnet, '-') !== false) {
/// 2: xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx-yyy or xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx::xxxx-yyyy ...a range of IP addresses in the last group.
$parts = explode('-', $subnet);
if (count($parts) != 2) {
continue;
}
if (strpos($subnet, ':') !== false) {
// IPv6
if (!$ipv6) {
continue;
}
$ipstart = cleanremoteaddr(trim($parts[0]), false); // normalise
if ($ipstart === null) {
continue;
}
$ipparts = explode(':', $ipstart);
$start = hexdec(array_pop($ipparts));
$ipparts[] = trim($parts[1]);
$ipend = cleanremoteaddr(implode(':', $ipparts), false); // normalise
if ($ipend === null) {
continue;
}
$ipparts[7] = '';
$ipnet = implode(':', $ipparts);
if (strpos($addr, $ipnet) !== 0) {
continue;
}
$ipparts = explode(':', $ipend);
$end = hexdec($ipparts[7]);
$addrend = hexdec($addrparts[7]);
if (($addrend >= $start) and ($addrend <= $end)) {
return true;
}
} else {
// IPv4
if ($ipv6) {
continue;
}
$ipstart = cleanremoteaddr(trim($parts[0]), false); // normalise
if ($ipstart === null) {
continue;
}
$ipparts = explode('.', $ipstart);
$ipparts[3] = trim($parts[1]);
$ipend = cleanremoteaddr(implode('.', $ipparts), false); // normalise
if ($ipend === null) {
continue;
}
if ((ip2long($addr) >= ip2long($ipstart)) and (ip2long($addr) <= ip2long($ipend))) {
return true;
}
}
} else {
/// 3: xxx.xxx or xxx.xxx. or xxx:xxx:xxxx or xxx:xxx:xxxx.
if (strpos($subnet, ':') !== false) {
// IPv6
if (!$ipv6) {
continue;
}
$parts = explode(':', $subnet);
$count = count($parts);
if ($parts[$count-1] === '') {
unset($parts[$count-1]); // trim trailing :
$count--;
$subnet = implode('.', $parts);
}
$isip = cleanremoteaddr($subnet, false); // normalise
if ($isip !== null) {
if ($isip === $addr) {
return true;
}
continue;
} else if ($count > 8) {
continue;
}
$zeros = array_fill(0, 8-$count, '0');
$subnet = $subnet.':'.implode(':', $zeros).'/'.($count*16);
if (address_in_subnet($addr, $subnet)) {
return true;
}
} else {
// IPv4
if ($ipv6) {
continue;
}
$parts = explode('.', $subnet);
$count = count($parts);
if ($parts[$count-1] === '') {
unset($parts[$count-1]); // trim trailing .
$count--;
$subnet = implode('.', $parts);
}
if ($count == 4) {
$subnet = cleanremoteaddr($subnet, false); // normalise
if ($subnet === $addr) {
return true;
}
continue;
} else if ($count > 4) {
continue;
}
$zeros = array_fill(0, 4-$count, '0');
$subnet = $subnet.'.'.implode('.', $zeros).'/'.($count*8);
if (address_in_subnet($addr, $subnet)) {
return true;
}
}
}
}
return false;
}
/**
* For outputting debugging info
*
* @uses STDOUT
* @param string $string The string to write
* @param string $eol The end of line char(s) to use
* @param string $sleep Period to make the application sleep
* This ensures any messages have time to display before redirect
*/
function mtrace($string, $eol="\n", $sleep=0) {
if (defined('STDOUT') and !PHPUNIT_TEST) {
fwrite(STDOUT, $string.$eol);
} else {
echo $string . $eol;
}
flush();
//delay to keep message on user's screen in case of subsequent redirect
if ($sleep) {
sleep($sleep);
}
}
/**
* Replace 1 or more slashes or backslashes to 1 slash
*
* @param string $path The path to strip
* @return string the path with double slashes removed
*/
function cleardoubleslashes ($path) {
return preg_replace('/(\/|\\\){1,}/','/',$path);
}
/**
* Is current ip in give list?
*
* @param string $list
* @return bool
*/
function remoteip_in_list($list){
$inlist = false;
$client_ip = getremoteaddr(null);
if(!$client_ip){
// ensure access on cli
return true;
}
$list = explode("\n", $list);
foreach($list as $subnet) {
$subnet = trim($subnet);
if (address_in_subnet($client_ip, $subnet)) {
$inlist = true;
break;
}
}
return $inlist;
}
/**
* Returns most reliable client address
*
* @global object
* @param string $default If an address can't be determined, then return this
* @return string The remote IP address
*/
function getremoteaddr($default='0.0.0.0') {
global $CFG;
if (empty($CFG->getremoteaddrconf)) {
// This will happen, for example, before just after the upgrade, as the
// user is redirected to the admin screen.
$variablestoskip = 0;
} else {
$variablestoskip = $CFG->getremoteaddrconf;
}
if (!($variablestoskip & GETREMOTEADDR_SKIP_HTTP_CLIENT_IP)) {
if (!empty($_SERVER['HTTP_CLIENT_IP'])) {
$address = cleanremoteaddr($_SERVER['HTTP_CLIENT_IP']);
return $address ? $address : $default;
}
}
if (!($variablestoskip & GETREMOTEADDR_SKIP_HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR)) {
if (!empty($_SERVER['HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR'])) {
$address = cleanremoteaddr($_SERVER['HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR']);
return $address ? $address : $default;
}
}
if (!empty($_SERVER['REMOTE_ADDR'])) {
$address = cleanremoteaddr($_SERVER['REMOTE_ADDR']);
return $address ? $address : $default;
} else {
return $default;
}
}
/**
* Cleans an ip address. Internal addresses are now allowed.
* (Originally local addresses were not allowed.)
*
* @param string $addr IPv4 or IPv6 address
* @param bool $compress use IPv6 address compression
* @return string normalised ip address string, null if error
*/
function cleanremoteaddr($addr, $compress=false) {
$addr = trim($addr);
//TODO: maybe add a separate function is_addr_public() or something like this
if (strpos($addr, ':') !== false) {
// can be only IPv6
$parts = explode(':', $addr);
$count = count($parts);
if (strpos($parts[$count-1], '.') !== false) {
//legacy ipv4 notation
$last = array_pop($parts);
$ipv4 = cleanremoteaddr($last, true);
if ($ipv4 === null) {
return null;
}
$bits = explode('.', $ipv4);
$parts[] = dechex($bits[0]).dechex($bits[1]);
$parts[] = dechex($bits[2]).dechex($bits[3]);
$count = count($parts);
$addr = implode(':', $parts);
}
if ($count < 3 or $count > 8) {
return null; // severly malformed
}
if ($count != 8) {
if (strpos($addr, '::') === false) {
return null; // malformed
}
// uncompress ::
$insertat = array_search('', $parts, true);
$missing = array_fill(0, 1 + 8 - $count, '0');
array_splice($parts, $insertat, 1, $missing);
foreach ($parts as $key=>$part) {
if ($part === '') {
$parts[$key] = '0';
}
}
}
$adr = implode(':', $parts);
if (!preg_match('/^([0-9a-f]{1,4})(:[0-9a-f]{1,4})*$/i', $adr)) {
return null; // incorrect format - sorry
}
// normalise 0s and case
$parts = array_map('hexdec', $parts);
$parts = array_map('dechex', $parts);
$result = implode(':', $parts);
if (!$compress) {
return $result;
}
if ($result === '0:0:0:0:0:0:0:0') {
return '::'; // all addresses
}
$compressed = preg_replace('/(:0)+:0$/', '::', $result, 1);
if ($compressed !== $result) {
return $compressed;
}
$compressed = preg_replace('/^(0:){2,7}/', '::', $result, 1);
if ($compressed !== $result) {
return $compressed;
}
$compressed = preg_replace('/(:0){2,6}:/', '::', $result, 1);
if ($compressed !== $result) {
return $compressed;
}
return $result;
}
// first get all things that look like IPv4 addresses
$parts = array();
if (!preg_match('/^(\d{1,3})\.(\d{1,3})\.(\d{1,3})\.(\d{1,3})$/', $addr, $parts)) {
return null;
}
unset($parts[0]);
foreach ($parts as $key=>$match) {
if ($match > 255) {
return null;
}
$parts[$key] = (int)$match; // normalise 0s
}
return implode('.', $parts);
}
/**
* This function will make a complete copy of anything it's given,
* regardless of whether it's an object or not.
*
* @param mixed $thing Something you want cloned
* @return mixed What ever it is you passed it
*/
function fullclone($thing) {
return unserialize(serialize($thing));
}
/**
* This function expects to called during shutdown
* should be set via register_shutdown_function()
* in lib/setup.php .
*
* @return void
*/
function moodle_request_shutdown() {
global $CFG;
// help apache server if possible
$apachereleasemem = false;
if (function_exists('apache_child_terminate') && function_exists('memory_get_usage')
&& ini_get_bool('child_terminate')) {
$limit = (empty($CFG->apachemaxmem) ? 64*1024*1024 : $CFG->apachemaxmem); //64MB default
if (memory_get_usage() > get_real_size($limit)) {
$apachereleasemem = $limit;
@apache_child_terminate();
}
}
// deal with perf logging
if (defined('MDL_PERF') || (!empty($CFG->perfdebug) and $CFG->perfdebug > 7)) {
if ($apachereleasemem) {
error_log('Mem usage over '.$apachereleasemem.': marking Apache child for reaping.');
}
if (defined('MDL_PERFTOLOG')) {
$perf = get_performance_info();
error_log("PERF: " . $perf['txt']);
}
if (defined('MDL_PERFINC')) {
$inc = get_included_files();
$ts = 0;
foreach($inc as $f) {
if (preg_match(':^/:', $f)) {
$fs = filesize($f);
$ts += $fs;
$hfs = display_size($fs);
error_log(substr($f,strlen($CFG->dirroot)) . " size: $fs ($hfs)"
, NULL, NULL, 0);
} else {
error_log($f , NULL, NULL, 0);
}
}
if ($ts > 0 ) {
$hts = display_size($ts);
error_log("Total size of files included: $ts ($hts)");
}
}
}
}
/**
* If new messages are waiting for the current user, then insert
* JavaScript to pop up the messaging window into the page
*
* @global moodle_page $PAGE
* @return void
*/
function message_popup_window() {
global $USER, $DB, $PAGE, $CFG, $SITE;
if (!$PAGE->get_popup_notification_allowed() || empty($CFG->messaging)) {
return;
}
if (!isloggedin() || isguestuser()) {
return;
}
if (!isset($USER->message_lastpopup)) {
$USER->message_lastpopup = 0;
} else if ($USER->message_lastpopup > (time()-120)) {
//dont run the query to check whether to display a popup if its been run in the last 2 minutes
return;
}
//a quick query to check whether the user has new messages
$messagecount = $DB->count_records('message', array('useridto' => $USER->id));
if ($messagecount<1) {
return;
}
//got unread messages so now do another query that joins with the user table
$messagesql = "SELECT m.id, m.smallmessage, m.fullmessageformat, m.notification, u.firstname, u.lastname
FROM {message} m
JOIN {message_working} mw ON m.id=mw.unreadmessageid
JOIN {message_processors} p ON mw.processorid=p.id
JOIN {user} u ON m.useridfrom=u.id
WHERE m.useridto = :userid
AND p.name='popup'";
//if the user was last notified over an hour ago we can renotify them of old messages
//so don't worry about when the new message was sent
$lastnotifiedlongago = $USER->message_lastpopup < (time()-3600);
if (!$lastnotifiedlongago) {
$messagesql .= 'AND m.timecreated > :lastpopuptime';
}
$message_users = $DB->get_records_sql($messagesql, array('userid'=>$USER->id, 'lastpopuptime'=>$USER->message_lastpopup));
//if we have new messages to notify the user about
if (!empty($message_users)) {
$strmessages = '';
if (count($message_users)>1) {
$strmessages = get_string('unreadnewmessages', 'message', count($message_users));
} else {
$message_users = reset($message_users);
//show who the message is from if its not a notification
if (!$message_users->notification) {
$strmessages = get_string('unreadnewmessage', 'message', fullname($message_users) );
}
//try to display the small version of the message
$smallmessage = null;
if (!empty($message_users->smallmessage)) {
//display the first 200 chars of the message in the popup
$smallmessage = null;
if (textlib::strlen($message_users->smallmessage) > 200) {
$smallmessage = textlib::substr($message_users->smallmessage,0,200).'...';
} else {
$smallmessage = $message_users->smallmessage;
}
//prevent html symbols being displayed
if ($message_users->fullmessageformat == FORMAT_HTML) {
$smallmessage = html_to_text($smallmessage);
} else {
$smallmessage = s($smallmessage);
}
} else if ($message_users->notification) {
//its a notification with no smallmessage so just say they have a notification
$smallmessage = get_string('unreadnewnotification', 'message');
}
if (!empty($smallmessage)) {
$strmessages .= '<div id="usermessage">'.s($smallmessage).'</div>';
}
}
$strgomessage = get_string('gotomessages', 'message');
$strstaymessage = get_string('ignore','admin');
$url = $CFG->wwwroot.'/message/index.php';
$content = html_writer::start_tag('div', array('id'=>'newmessageoverlay','class'=>'mdl-align')).
html_writer::start_tag('div', array('id'=>'newmessagetext')).
$strmessages.
html_writer::end_tag('div').
html_writer::start_tag('div', array('id'=>'newmessagelinks')).
html_writer::link($url, $strgomessage, array('id'=>'notificationyes')).'&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;'.
html_writer::link('', $strstaymessage, array('id'=>'notificationno')).
html_writer::end_tag('div');
html_writer::end_tag('div');
$PAGE->requires->js_init_call('M.core_message.init_notification', array('', $content, $url));
$USER->message_lastpopup = time();
}
}
/**
* Used to make sure that $min <= $value <= $max
*
* Make sure that value is between min, and max
*
* @param int $min The minimum value
* @param int $value The value to check
* @param int $max The maximum value
*/
function bounded_number($min, $value, $max) {
if($value < $min) {
return $min;
}
if($value > $max) {
return $max;
}
return $value;
}
/**
* Check if there is a nested array within the passed array
*
* @param array $array
* @return bool true if there is a nested array false otherwise
*/
function array_is_nested($array) {
foreach ($array as $value) {
if (is_array($value)) {
return true;
}
}
return false;
}
/**
* get_performance_info() pairs up with init_performance_info()
* loaded in setup.php. Returns an array with 'html' and 'txt'
* values ready for use, and each of the individual stats provided
* separately as well.
*
* @global object
* @global object
* @global object
* @return array
*/
function get_performance_info() {
global $CFG, $PERF, $DB, $PAGE;
$info = array();
$info['html'] = ''; // holds userfriendly HTML representation
$info['txt'] = me() . ' '; // holds log-friendly representation
$info['realtime'] = microtime_diff($PERF->starttime, microtime());
$info['html'] .= '<span class="timeused">'.$info['realtime'].' secs</span> ';
$info['txt'] .= 'time: '.$info['realtime'].'s ';
if (function_exists('memory_get_usage')) {
$info['memory_total'] = memory_get_usage();
$info['memory_growth'] = memory_get_usage() - $PERF->startmemory;
$info['html'] .= '<span class="memoryused">RAM: '.display_size($info['memory_total']).'</span> ';
$info['txt'] .= 'memory_total: '.$info['memory_total'].'B (' . display_size($info['memory_total']).') memory_growth: '.$info['memory_growth'].'B ('.display_size($info['memory_growth']).') ';
}
if (function_exists('memory_get_peak_usage')) {
$info['memory_peak'] = memory_get_peak_usage();
$info['html'] .= '<span class="memoryused">RAM peak: '.display_size($info['memory_peak']).'</span> ';
$info['txt'] .= 'memory_peak: '.$info['memory_peak'].'B (' . display_size($info['memory_peak']).') ';
}
$inc = get_included_files();
//error_log(print_r($inc,1));
$info['includecount'] = count($inc);
$info['html'] .= '<span class="included">Included '.$info['includecount'].' files</span> ';
$info['txt'] .= 'includecount: '.$info['includecount'].' ';
if (!empty($CFG->early_install_lang)) {
// We can not track more performance before installation, sorry.
return $info;
}
$filtermanager = filter_manager::instance();
if (method_exists($filtermanager, 'get_performance_summary')) {
list($filterinfo, $nicenames) = $filtermanager->get_performance_summary();
$info = array_merge($filterinfo, $info);
foreach ($filterinfo as $key => $value) {
$info['html'] .= "<span class='$key'>$nicenames[$key]: $value </span> ";
$info['txt'] .= "$key: $value ";
}
}
$stringmanager = get_string_manager();
if (method_exists($stringmanager, 'get_performance_summary')) {
list($filterinfo, $nicenames) = $stringmanager->get_performance_summary();
$info = array_merge($filterinfo, $info);
foreach ($filterinfo as $key => $value) {
$info['html'] .= "<span class='$key'>$nicenames[$key]: $value </span> ";
$info['txt'] .= "$key: $value ";
}
}
$jsmodules = $PAGE->requires->get_loaded_modules();
if ($jsmodules) {
$yuicount = 0;
$othercount = 0;
$details = '';
foreach ($jsmodules as $module => $backtraces) {
if (strpos($module, 'yui') === 0) {
$yuicount += 1;
} else {
$othercount += 1;
}
if (!empty($CFG->yuimoduledebug)) {
// hidden feature for developers working on YUI module infrastructure
$details .= "<div class='yui-module'><p>$module</p>";
foreach ($backtraces as $backtrace) {
$details .= "<div class='backtrace'>$backtrace</div>";
}
$details .= '</div>';
}
}
$info['html'] .= "<span class='includedyuimodules'>Included YUI modules: $yuicount</span> ";
$info['txt'] .= "includedyuimodules: $yuicount ";
$info['html'] .= "<span class='includedjsmodules'>Other JavaScript modules: $othercount</span> ";
$info['txt'] .= "includedjsmodules: $othercount ";
if ($details) {
$info['html'] .= '<div id="yui-module-debug" class="notifytiny">'.$details.'</div>';
}
}
if (!empty($PERF->logwrites)) {
$info['logwrites'] = $PERF->logwrites;
$info['html'] .= '<span class="logwrites">Log DB writes '.$info['logwrites'].'</span> ';
$info['txt'] .= 'logwrites: '.$info['logwrites'].' ';
}
$info['dbqueries'] = $DB->perf_get_reads().'/'.($DB->perf_get_writes() - $PERF->logwrites);
$info['html'] .= '<span class="dbqueries">DB reads/writes: '.$info['dbqueries'].'</span> ';
$info['txt'] .= 'db reads/writes: '.$info['dbqueries'].' ';
if (function_exists('posix_times')) {
$ptimes = posix_times();
if (is_array($ptimes)) {
foreach ($ptimes as $key => $val) {
$info[$key] = $ptimes[$key] - $PERF->startposixtimes[$key];
}
$info['html'] .= "<span class=\"posixtimes\">ticks: $info[ticks] user: $info[utime] sys: $info[stime] cuser: $info[cutime] csys: $info[cstime]</span> ";
$info['txt'] .= "ticks: $info[ticks] user: $info[utime] sys: $info[stime] cuser: $info[cutime] csys: $info[cstime] ";
}
}
// Grab the load average for the last minute
// /proc will only work under some linux configurations
// while uptime is there under MacOSX/Darwin and other unices
if (is_readable('/proc/loadavg') && $loadavg = @file('/proc/loadavg')) {
list($server_load) = explode(' ', $loadavg[0]);
unset($loadavg);
} else if ( function_exists('is_executable') && is_executable('/usr/bin/uptime') && $loadavg = `/usr/bin/uptime` ) {
if (preg_match('/load averages?: (\d+[\.,:]\d+)/', $loadavg, $matches)) {
$server_load = $matches[1];
} else {
trigger_error('Could not parse uptime output!');
}
}
if (!empty($server_load)) {
$info['serverload'] = $server_load;
$info['html'] .= '<span class="serverload">Load average: '.$info['serverload'].'</span> ';
$info['txt'] .= "serverload: {$info['serverload']} ";
}
// Display size of session if session started
if (session_id()) {
$info['sessionsize'] = display_size(strlen(session_encode()));
$info['html'] .= '<span class="sessionsize">Session: ' . $info['sessionsize'] . '</span> ';
$info['txt'] .= "Session: {$info['sessionsize']} ";
}
if ($stats = cache_helper::get_stats()) {
$html = '<span class="cachesused">';
$html .= '<span class="cache-stats-heading">Caches used (hits/misses/sets)</span>';
$text = 'Caches used (hits/misses/sets): ';
$hits = 0;
$misses = 0;
$sets = 0;
foreach ($stats as $definition => $stores) {
$html .= '<span class="cache-definition-stats">';
$html .= '<span class="cache-definition-stats-heading">'.$definition.'</span>';
$text .= "$definition {";
foreach ($stores as $store => $data) {
$hits += $data['hits'];
$misses += $data['misses'];
$sets += $data['sets'];
if ($data['hits'] == 0 and $data['misses'] > 0) {
$cachestoreclass = 'nohits';
} else if ($data['hits'] < $data['misses']) {
$cachestoreclass = 'lowhits';
} else {
$cachestoreclass = 'hihits';
}
$text .= "$store($data[hits]/$data[misses]/$data[sets]) ";
$html .= "<span class=\"cache-store-stats $cachestoreclass\">$store: $data[hits] / $data[misses] / $data[sets]</span>";
}
$html .= '</span>';
$text .= '} ';
}
$html .= "<span class='cache-total-stats'>Total: $hits / $misses / $sets</span>";
$html .= '</span> ';
$info['cachesused'] = "$hits / $misses / $sets";
$info['html'] .= $html;
$info['txt'] .= $text.'. ';
} else {
$info['cachesused'] = '0 / 0 / 0';
$info['html'] .= '<span class="cachesused">Caches used (hits/misses/sets): 0/0/0</span>';
$info['txt'] .= 'Caches used (hits/misses/sets): 0/0/0 ';
}
$info['html'] = '<div class="performanceinfo siteinfo">'.$info['html'].'</div>';
return $info;
}
/**
* @todo Document this function linux people
*/
function apd_get_profiling() {
return shell_exec('pprofp -u ' . ini_get('apd.dumpdir') . '/pprof.' . getmypid() . '.*');
}
/**
* Delete directory or only its content
*
* @param string $dir directory path
* @param bool $content_only
* @return bool success, true also if dir does not exist
*/
function remove_dir($dir, $content_only=false) {
if (!file_exists($dir)) {
// nothing to do
return true;
}
if (!$handle = opendir($dir)) {
return false;
}
$result = true;
while (false!==($item = readdir($handle))) {
if($item != '.' && $item != '..') {
if(is_dir($dir.'/'.$item)) {
$result = remove_dir($dir.'/'.$item) && $result;
}else{
$result = unlink($dir.'/'.$item) && $result;
}
}
}
closedir($handle);
if ($content_only) {
clearstatcache(); // make sure file stat cache is properly invalidated
return $result;
}
$result = rmdir($dir); // if anything left the result will be false, no need for && $result
clearstatcache(); // make sure file stat cache is properly invalidated
return $result;
}
/**
* Detect if an object or a class contains a given property
* will take an actual object or the name of a class
*
* @param mix $obj Name of class or real object to test
* @param string $property name of property to find
* @return bool true if property exists
*/
function object_property_exists( $obj, $property ) {
if (is_string( $obj )) {
$properties = get_class_vars( $obj );
}
else {
$properties = get_object_vars( $obj );
}
return array_key_exists( $property, $properties );
}
/**
* Converts an object into an associative array
*
* This function converts an object into an associative array by iterating
* over its public properties. Because this function uses the foreach
* construct, Iterators are respected. It works recursively on arrays of objects.
* Arrays and simple values are returned as is.
*
* If class has magic properties, it can implement IteratorAggregate
* and return all available properties in getIterator()
*
* @param mixed $var
* @return array
*/
function convert_to_array($var) {
$result = array();
// loop over elements/properties
foreach ($var as $key => $value) {
// recursively convert objects
if (is_object($value) || is_array($value)) {
$result[$key] = convert_to_array($value);
} else {
// simple values are untouched
$result[$key] = $value;
}
}
return $result;
}
/**
* Detect a custom script replacement in the data directory that will
* replace an existing moodle script
*
* @return string|bool full path name if a custom script exists, false if no custom script exists
*/
function custom_script_path() {
global $CFG, $SCRIPT;
if ($SCRIPT === null) {
// Probably some weird external script
return false;
}
$scriptpath = $CFG->customscripts . $SCRIPT;
// check the custom script exists
if (file_exists($scriptpath) and is_file($scriptpath)) {
return $scriptpath;
} else {
return false;
}
}
/**
* Returns whether or not the user object is a remote MNET user. This function
* is in moodlelib because it does not rely on loading any of the MNET code.
*
* @global object
* @param object $user A valid user object
* @return bool True if the user is from a remote Moodle.
*/
function is_mnet_remote_user($user) {
global $CFG;
if (!isset($CFG->mnet_localhost_id)) {
include_once $CFG->dirroot . '/mnet/lib.php';
$env = new mnet_environment();
$env->init();
unset($env);
}
return (!empty($user->mnethostid) && $user->mnethostid != $CFG->mnet_localhost_id);
}
/**
* This function will search for browser prefereed languages, setting Moodle
* to use the best one available if $SESSION->lang is undefined
*
* @global object
* @global object
* @global object
*/
function setup_lang_from_browser() {
global $CFG, $SESSION, $USER;
if (!empty($SESSION->lang) or !empty($USER->lang) or empty($CFG->autolang)) {
// Lang is defined in session or user profile, nothing to do
return;
}
if (!isset($_SERVER['HTTP_ACCEPT_LANGUAGE'])) { // There isn't list of browser langs, nothing to do
return;
}
/// Extract and clean langs from headers
$rawlangs = $_SERVER['HTTP_ACCEPT_LANGUAGE'];
$rawlangs = str_replace('-', '_', $rawlangs); // we are using underscores
$rawlangs = explode(',', $rawlangs); // Convert to array
$langs = array();
$order = 1.0;
foreach ($rawlangs as $lang) {
if (strpos($lang, ';') === false) {
$langs[(string)$order] = $lang;
$order = $order-0.01;
} else {
$parts = explode(';', $lang);
$pos = strpos($parts[1], '=');
$langs[substr($parts[1], $pos+1)] = $parts[0];
}
}
krsort($langs, SORT_NUMERIC);
/// Look for such langs under standard locations
foreach ($langs as $lang) {
$lang = strtolower(clean_param($lang, PARAM_SAFEDIR)); // clean it properly for include
if (get_string_manager()->translation_exists($lang, false)) {
$SESSION->lang = $lang; /// Lang exists, set it in session
break; /// We have finished. Go out
}
}
return;
}
/**
* check if $url matches anything in proxybypass list
*
* any errors just result in the proxy being used (least bad)
*
* @global object
* @param string $url url to check
* @return boolean true if we should bypass the proxy
*/
function is_proxybypass( $url ) {
global $CFG;
// sanity check
if (empty($CFG->proxyhost) or empty($CFG->proxybypass)) {
return false;
}
// get the host part out of the url
if (!$host = parse_url( $url, PHP_URL_HOST )) {
return false;
}
// get the possible bypass hosts into an array
$matches = explode( ',', $CFG->proxybypass );
// check for a match
// (IPs need to match the left hand side and hosts the right of the url,
// but we can recklessly check both as there can't be a false +ve)
$bypass = false;
foreach ($matches as $match) {
$match = trim($match);
// try for IP match (Left side)
$lhs = substr($host,0,strlen($match));
if (strcasecmp($match,$lhs)==0) {
return true;
}
// try for host match (Right side)
$rhs = substr($host,-strlen($match));
if (strcasecmp($match,$rhs)==0) {
return true;
}
}
// nothing matched.
return false;
}
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
/**
* Check if the passed navigation is of the new style
*
* @param mixed $navigation
* @return bool true for yes false for no
*/
function is_newnav($navigation) {
if (is_array($navigation) && !empty($navigation['newnav'])) {
return true;
} else {
return false;
}
}
/**
* Checks whether the given variable name is defined as a variable within the given object.
*
* This will NOT work with stdClass objects, which have no class variables.
*
* @param string $var The variable name
* @param object $object The object to check
* @return boolean
*/
function in_object_vars($var, $object) {
$class_vars = get_class_vars(get_class($object));
$class_vars = array_keys($class_vars);
return in_array($var, $class_vars);
}
/**
* Returns an array without repeated objects.
* This function is similar to array_unique, but for arrays that have objects as values
*
* @param array $array
* @param bool $keep_key_assoc
* @return array
*/
function object_array_unique($array, $keep_key_assoc = true) {
$duplicate_keys = array();
$tmp = array();
foreach ($array as $key=>$val) {
// convert objects to arrays, in_array() does not support objects
if (is_object($val)) {
$val = (array)$val;
}
if (!in_array($val, $tmp)) {
$tmp[] = $val;
} else {
$duplicate_keys[] = $key;
}
}
foreach ($duplicate_keys as $key) {
unset($array[$key]);
}
return $keep_key_assoc ? $array : array_values($array);
}
/**
* Is a userid the primary administrator?
*
* @param int $userid int id of user to check
* @return boolean
*/
function is_primary_admin($userid){
$primaryadmin = get_admin();
if($userid == $primaryadmin->id){
return true;
}else{
return false;
}
}
/**
* Returns the site identifier
*
* @global object
* @return string $CFG->siteidentifier, first making sure it is properly initialised.
*/
function get_site_identifier() {
global $CFG;
// Check to see if it is missing. If so, initialise it.
if (empty($CFG->siteidentifier)) {
set_config('siteidentifier', random_string(32) . $_SERVER['HTTP_HOST']);
}
// Return it.
return $CFG->siteidentifier;
}
/**
* Check whether the given password has no more than the specified
* number of consecutive identical characters.
*
* @param string $password password to be checked against the password policy
* @param integer $maxchars maximum number of consecutive identical characters
*/
function check_consecutive_identical_characters($password, $maxchars) {
if ($maxchars < 1) {
return true; // 0 is to disable this check
}
if (strlen($password) <= $maxchars) {
return true; // too short to fail this test
}
$previouschar = '';
$consecutivecount = 1;
foreach (str_split($password) as $char) {
if ($char != $previouschar) {
$consecutivecount = 1;
}
else {
$consecutivecount++;
if ($consecutivecount > $maxchars) {
return false; // check failed already
}
}
$previouschar = $char;
}
return true;
}
/**
* helper function to do partial function binding
* so we can use it for preg_replace_callback, for example
* this works with php functions, user functions, static methods and class methods
* it returns you a callback that you can pass on like so:
*
* $callback = partial('somefunction', $arg1, $arg2);
* or
* $callback = partial(array('someclass', 'somestaticmethod'), $arg1, $arg2);
* or even
* $obj = new someclass();
* $callback = partial(array($obj, 'somemethod'), $arg1, $arg2);
*
* and then the arguments that are passed through at calltime are appended to the argument list.
*
* @param mixed $function a php callback
* $param mixed $arg1.. $argv arguments to partially bind with
*
* @return callback
*/
function partial() {
if (!class_exists('partial')) {
class partial{
var $values = array();
var $func;
function __construct($func, $args) {
$this->values = $args;
$this->func = $func;
}
function method() {
$args = func_get_args();
return call_user_func_array($this->func, array_merge($this->values, $args));
}
}
}
$args = func_get_args();
$func = array_shift($args);
$p = new partial($func, $args);
return array($p, 'method');
}
/**
* helper function to load up and initialise the mnet environment
* this must be called before you use mnet functions.
*
* @return mnet_environment the equivalent of old $MNET global
*/
function get_mnet_environment() {
global $CFG;
require_once($CFG->dirroot . '/mnet/lib.php');
static $instance = null;
if (empty($instance)) {
$instance = new mnet_environment();
$instance->init();
}
return $instance;
}
/**
* during xmlrpc server code execution, any code wishing to access
* information about the remote peer must use this to get it.
*
* @return mnet_remote_client the equivalent of old $MNET_REMOTE_CLIENT global
*/
function get_mnet_remote_client() {
if (!defined('MNET_SERVER')) {
debugging(get_string('notinxmlrpcserver', 'mnet'));
return false;
}
global $MNET_REMOTE_CLIENT;
if (isset($MNET_REMOTE_CLIENT)) {
return $MNET_REMOTE_CLIENT;
}
return false;
}
/**
* during the xmlrpc server code execution, this will be called
* to setup the object returned by {@see get_mnet_remote_client}
*
* @param mnet_remote_client $client the client to set up
*/
function set_mnet_remote_client($client) {
if (!defined('MNET_SERVER')) {
throw new moodle_exception('notinxmlrpcserver', 'mnet');
}
global $MNET_REMOTE_CLIENT;
$MNET_REMOTE_CLIENT = $client;
}
/**
* return the jump url for a given remote user
* this is used for rewriting forum post links in emails, etc
*
* @param stdclass $user the user to get the idp url for
*/
function mnet_get_idp_jump_url($user) {
global $CFG;
static $mnetjumps = array();
if (!array_key_exists($user->mnethostid, $mnetjumps)) {
$idp = mnet_get_peer_host($user->mnethostid);
$idpjumppath = mnet_get_app_jumppath($idp->applicationid);
$mnetjumps[$user->mnethostid] = $idp->wwwroot . $idpjumppath . '?hostwwwroot=' . $CFG->wwwroot . '&wantsurl=';
}
return $mnetjumps[$user->mnethostid];
}
/**
* Gets the homepage to use for the current user
*
* @return int One of HOMEPAGE_*
*/
function get_home_page() {
global $CFG;
if (isloggedin() && !isguestuser() && !empty($CFG->defaulthomepage)) {
if ($CFG->defaulthomepage == HOMEPAGE_MY) {
return HOMEPAGE_MY;
} else {
return (int)get_user_preferences('user_home_page_preference', HOMEPAGE_MY);
}
}
return HOMEPAGE_SITE;
}
/**
* Gets the name of a course to be displayed when showing a list of courses.
* By default this is just $course->fullname but user can configure it. The
* result of this function should be passed through print_string.
* @param stdClass|course_in_list $course Moodle course object
* @return string Display name of course (either fullname or short + fullname)
*/
function get_course_display_name_for_list($course) {
global $CFG;
if (!empty($CFG->courselistshortnames)) {
if (!($course instanceof stdClass)) {
$course = (object)convert_to_array($course);
}
return get_string('courseextendednamedisplay', '', $course);
} else {
return $course->fullname;
}
}
/**
* The lang_string class
*
* This special class is used to create an object representation of a string request.
* It is special because processing doesn't occur until the object is first used.
* The class was created especially to aid performance in areas where strings were
* required to be generated but were not necessarily used.
* As an example the admin tree when generated uses over 1500 strings, of which
* normally only 1/3 are ever actually printed at any time.
* The performance advantage is achieved by not actually processing strings that
* arn't being used, as such reducing the processing required for the page.
*
* How to use the lang_string class?
* There are two methods of using the lang_string class, first through the
* forth argument of the get_string function, and secondly directly.
* The following are examples of both.
* 1. Through get_string calls e.g.
* $string = get_string($identifier, $component, $a, true);
* $string = get_string('yes', 'moodle', null, true);
* 2. Direct instantiation
* $string = new lang_string($identifier, $component, $a, $lang);
* $string = new lang_string('yes');
*
* How do I use a lang_string object?
* The lang_string object makes use of a magic __toString method so that you
* are able to use the object exactly as you would use a string in most cases.
* This means you are able to collect it into a variable and then directly
* echo it, or concatenate it into another string, or similar.
* The other thing you can do is manually get the string by calling the
* lang_strings out method e.g.
* $string = new lang_string('yes');
* $string->out();
* Also worth noting is that the out method can take one argument, $lang which
* allows the developer to change the language on the fly.
*
* When should I use a lang_string object?
* The lang_string object is designed to be used in any situation where a
* string may not be needed, but needs to be generated.
* The admin tree is a good example of where lang_string objects should be
* used.
* A more practical example would be any class that requries strings that may
* not be printed (after all classes get renderer by renderers and who knows
* what they will do ;))
*
* When should I not use a lang_string object?
* Don't use lang_strings when you are going to use a string immediately.
* There is no need as it will be processed immediately and there will be no
* advantage, and in fact perhaps a negative hit as a class has to be
* instantiated for a lang_string object, however get_string won't require
* that.
*
* Limitations:
* 1. You cannot use a lang_string object as an array offset. Doing so will
* result in PHP throwing an error. (You can use it as an object property!)
*
* @package core
* @category string
* @copyright 2011 Sam Hemelryk
* @license http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/gpl.html GNU GPL v3 or later
*/
class lang_string {
/** @var string The strings identifier */
protected $identifier;
/** @var string The strings component. Default '' */
protected $component = '';
/** @var array|stdClass Any arguments required for the string. Default null */
protected $a = null;
/** @var string The language to use when processing the string. Default null */
protected $lang = null;
/** @var string The processed string (once processed) */
protected $string = null;
/**
* A special boolean. If set to true then the object has been woken up and
* cannot be regenerated. If this is set then $this->string MUST be used.
* @var bool
*/
protected $forcedstring = false;
/**
* Constructs a lang_string object
*
* This function should do as little processing as possible to ensure the best
* performance for strings that won't be used.
*
* @param string $identifier The strings identifier
* @param string $component The strings component
* @param stdClass|array $a Any arguments the string requires
* @param string $lang The language to use when processing the string.
*/
public function __construct($identifier, $component = '', $a = null, $lang = null) {
if (empty($component)) {
$component = 'moodle';
}
$this->identifier = $identifier;
$this->component = $component;
$this->lang = $lang;
// We MUST duplicate $a to ensure that it if it changes by reference those
// changes are not carried across.
// To do this we always ensure $a or its properties/values are strings
// and that any properties/values that arn't convertable are forgotten.
if (!empty($a)) {
if (is_scalar($a)) {
$this->a = $a;
} else if ($a instanceof lang_string) {
$this->a = $a->out();
} else if (is_object($a) or is_array($a)) {
$a = (array)$a;
$this->a = array();
foreach ($a as $key => $value) {
// Make sure conversion errors don't get displayed (results in '')
if (is_array($value)) {
$this->a[$key] = '';
} else if (is_object($value)) {
if (method_exists($value, '__toString')) {
$this->a[$key] = $value->__toString();
} else {
$this->a[$key] = '';
}
} else {
$this->a[$key] = (string)$value;
}
}
}
}
if (debugging(false, DEBUG_DEVELOPER)) {
if (clean_param($this->identifier, PARAM_STRINGID) == '') {
throw new coding_exception('Invalid string identifier. Most probably some illegal character is part of the string identifier. Please check your string definition');
}
if (!empty($this->component) && clean_param($this->component, PARAM_COMPONENT) == '') {
throw new coding_exception('Invalid string compontent. Please check your string definition');
}
if (!get_string_manager()->string_exists($this->identifier, $this->component)) {
debugging('String does not exist. Please check your string definition for '.$this->identifier.'/'.$this->component, DEBUG_DEVELOPER);
}
}
}
/**
* Processes the string.
*
* This function actually processes the string, stores it in the string property
* and then returns it.
* You will notice that this function is VERY similar to the get_string method.
* That is because it is pretty much doing the same thing.
* However as this function is an upgrade it isn't as tolerant to backwards
* compatability.
*
* @return string
*/
protected function get_string() {
global $CFG;
// Check if we need to process the string
if ($this->string === null) {
// Check the quality of the identifier.
if (clean_param($this->identifier, PARAM_STRINGID) == '') {
throw new coding_exception('Invalid string identifier. Most probably some illegal character is part of the string identifier. Please check your string definition');
}
// Process the string
$this->string = get_string_manager()->get_string($this->identifier, $this->component, $this->a, $this->lang);
// Debugging feature lets you display string identifier and component
if (isset($CFG->debugstringids) && $CFG->debugstringids && optional_param('strings', 0, PARAM_INT)) {
$this->string .= ' {' . $this->identifier . '/' . $this->component . '}';
}
}
// Return the string
return $this->string;
}
/**
* Returns the string
*
* @param string $lang The langauge to use when processing the string
* @return string
*/
public function out($lang = null) {
if ($lang !== null && $lang != $this->lang && ($this->lang == null && $lang != current_language())) {
if ($this->forcedstring) {
debugging('lang_string objects that have been serialised and unserialised cannot be printed in another language. ('.$this->lang.' used)', DEBUG_DEVELOPER);
return $this->get_string();
}
$translatedstring = new lang_string($this->identifier, $this->component, $this->a, $lang);
return $translatedstring->out();
}
return $this->get_string();
}
/**
* Magic __toString method for printing a string
*
* @return string
*/
public function __toString() {
return $this->get_string();
}
/**
* Magic __set_state method used for var_export
*
* @return string
*/
public function __set_state() {
return $this->get_string();
}
/**
* Prepares the lang_string for sleep and stores only the forcedstring and
* string properties... the string cannot be regenerated so we need to ensure
* it is generated for this.
*
* @return string
*/
public function __sleep() {
$this->get_string();
$this->forcedstring = true;
return array('forcedstring', 'string', 'lang');
}
}